06d90faca1108b5b8b57f20b2b8df3b40782d5dd
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, no Front-Cover Texts, and no Back-Cover Texts. A
34 copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU Free
35 Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
83 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
84 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
85 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
86 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
87
88 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
89 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
90 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
91 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
92 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
93 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
94 @end menu
95
96 @node About
97 @unnumbered About
98 @cindex about
99
100 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
101 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
102 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
103 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
104 around the world.
105
106 @section What is OpenOCD?
107 @cindex TAP
108 @cindex JTAG
109
110 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
111 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
112 devices.
113
114 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
115 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
116 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
117 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
118 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
119 needed to hook up to the target.
120
121 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
122 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
123 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
124 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
125 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
126
127 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
128 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
129 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
130 let the development board connect directly to the debug
131 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
132
133 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
134 signaling, and is used to communicate
135 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
136 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
137 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
138 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
139 scan operations.
140
141 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
142 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
143 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
144 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
145
146 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
147 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
148 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
149 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
150
151
152 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
153 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
154 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
155
156 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
157 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
158 (Stellaris LM3, STMicroelectronics STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and
159 Intel Quark (x10xx) based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
160
161 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
162 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
163 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
164 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
165 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
166
167 @section OpenOCD Web Site
168
169 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
170
171 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
172
173 @section Latest User's Guide:
174
175 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
176 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
177 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
178
179 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
180
181 PDF form is likewise published at:
182
183 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
184
185 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
186
187 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
188 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
189 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
190 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
191 instead of this forum.
192
193 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
194
195 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
196
197 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
198 communication between users:
199
200 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
201
202 @section OpenOCD IRC
203
204 Support can also be found on irc:
205 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
206
207 @node Developers
208 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
209 @cindex developers
210
211 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
212 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
213 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
214 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
215
216 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
217 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
218
219 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
220
221 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
222 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
223
224 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
225
226 or via http
227
228 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
229
230 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
231
232 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
233
234 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
235 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
236 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
237 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
238 needing a Git client:
239
240 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
241
242 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
243 from the repository or a snapshot.
244
245 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
246 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
247 Patches created against older versions may require additional
248 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
249
250 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
251
252 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
253 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
254 technical information about the software internals, development
255 processes, and similar documentation:
256
257 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
258
259 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
260 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
261 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
262
263 @section Gerrit Review System
264
265 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
266 Code Review System:
267
268 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
269
270 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
271 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
272 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
273 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
274 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
275
276 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
277 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
278 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
279 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
280 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
281
282 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
283
284 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
285 communication between developers:
286
287 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
288
289 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
290
291 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
292
293 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
294
295
296 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
297 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @cindex dongles
299 @cindex FTDI
300 @cindex wiggler
301 @cindex zy1000
302 @cindex printer port
303 @cindex USB Adapter
304 @cindex RTCK
305
306 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
307 an adapter .... [snip]
308
309 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
310 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
311 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
312 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
313 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
314 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
315 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
316
317
318 @section Choosing a Dongle
319
320 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
321
322 @enumerate
323 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
324 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
325 other ways to communicate with target devices.
326 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
327 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
328 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
329 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
330 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
331 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
332 Ethernet port needed?
333 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
334 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
335 @end enumerate
336
337 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
338
339 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
340 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
341 running on the developer's host computer.
342 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
343 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
344 IP address assigned to the probe.
345 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
346 OpenOCD debugger.
347 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
348 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
349 the target.
350 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
351 to power cycle the target remotely.
352
353 For more information, visit:
354
355 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
356
357 @section USB FT2232 Based
358
359 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
360 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
361 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
362 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
363 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
364 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
365 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
366 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
367 clocking.)
368
369 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
370 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
371 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
372 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
373 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
374
375 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
376 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
377
378 @itemize @bullet
379 @item @b{usbjtag}
380 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
381 @item @b{jtagkey}
382 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
383 @item @b{jtagkey2}
384 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
385 @item @b{oocdlink}
386 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
387 @item @b{signalyzer}
388 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
389 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
390 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
391 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
392 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
393 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
394 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
395 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
396 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
397 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
398 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
399 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
400 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
401 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
402 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
403 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
404 @item @b{turtelizer2}
405 @* See:
406 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
407 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
408 @item @b{comstick}
409 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
410 @item @b{stm32stick}
411 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
412 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
413 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
414 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
415 @item @b{cortino}
416 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
417 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
418 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
419 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
420 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
421 @item @b{opendous}
422 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
423 (OpenHardware).
424 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
425 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
426
427 @item @b{GW16042}
428 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
429 FT2232H-based
430
431 @end itemize
432 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
433
434 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
435 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
436 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
437 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
438 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
439
440 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
441 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
442 (see the section on driver commands).
443
444 @itemize
445 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
446 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
447 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
448 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
449 @end itemize
450
451 @section USB J-Link based
452 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
453 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
454 AT91SAM764 internally.
455
456 @itemize @bullet
457 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
458 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
459 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
460 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
461 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
462 @end itemize
463
464 @section USB RLINK based
465 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
466 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
467 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
468
469 @itemize @bullet
470 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
471 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
472 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
473 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
474 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
475 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
476 @end itemize
477
478 @section USB ST-LINK based
479 STMicroelectronics has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
480 They only work with STMicroelectronics chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
481
482 @itemize @bullet
483 @item @b{ST-LINK}
484 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
485 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
486 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
487 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
488 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
489 @item @b{STLINK-V3}
490 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits.
491 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/stlink-v3}
492 @end itemize
493
494 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
495 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
496 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
497 @itemize @bullet
498 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
499 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
500 @end itemize
501
502 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
503 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
504 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
505 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
506
507 @section USB Nuvoton Nu-Link
508 Nuvoton has an adapter called @b{Nu-Link}.
509 It is available either as stand-alone dongle and embedded on development boards.
510 It supports SWD, serial port bridge and mass storage for firmware update.
511 Both Nu-Link v1 and v2 are supported.
512
513 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
514 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
515 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
516
517 @section USB Other
518 @itemize @bullet
519 @item @b{USBprog}
520 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
521
522 @item @b{USB - Presto}
523 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
524
525 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
526 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
527
528 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
529 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
530
531 @item @b{Buspirate}
532 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
533
534 @item @b{opendous}
535 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
536
537 @item @b{estick}
538 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
539
540 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
541 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
542
543 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
544 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds110.html}
545 @* Link: @url{https://software-dl.ti.com/ccs/esd/documents/xdsdebugprobes/emu_xds_software_package_download.html#xds110-support-utilities}
546 @end itemize
547
548 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
549
550 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
551 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
552 these on the market.
553
554 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
555 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
556 of USB-based ones.
557
558 @itemize @bullet
559
560 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
561 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
562
563 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
564 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
565 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
566
567 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
568 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
569
570 @item @b{Wiggler2}
571 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
572
573 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
574 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
575
576 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
577 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
578
579 @item @b{arm-jtag}
580 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
581
582 @item @b{chameleon}
583 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
584
585 @item @b{Triton}
586 @* Unknown.
587
588 @item @b{Lattice}
589 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
590 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
591
592 @item @b{flashlink}
593 @* From STMicroelectronics;
594 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
595
596 @end itemize
597
598 @section Other...
599 @itemize @bullet
600
601 @item @b{ep93xx}
602 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
603
604 @item @b{at91rm9200}
605 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
606
607 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
608 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
609
610 @item @b{imx_gpio}
611 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
612
613 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
614 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
615 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
616
617 @item @b{jtag_dpi}
618 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the SystemVerilog Direct Programming
619 Interface (DPI) for JTAG devices. DPI allows OpenOCD to connect to the JTAG
620 interface of a hardware model written in SystemVerilog, for example, on an
621 emulation model of target hardware.
622
623 @item @b{xlnx_pcie_xvc}
624 @* A JTAG driver exposing Xilinx Virtual Cable over PCI Express to OpenOCD as JTAG/SWD interface.
625
626 @item @b{linuxgpiod}
627 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux GPIO through library libgpiod.
628
629 @item @b{sysfsgpio}
630 @* A bitbang JTAG driver using Linux legacy sysfs GPIO.
631 This is deprecated from Linux v5.3; prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}.
632
633 @end itemize
634
635 @node About Jim-Tcl
636 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
637 @cindex Jim-Tcl
638 @cindex tcl
639
640 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
641 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
642 command interpreter.
643
644 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
645 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
646 much of anything about Tcl.
647 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
648
649 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
650 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
651 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
652 OpenOCD mailing list.
653
654 @itemize @bullet
655 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
656 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
657 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
658 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
659 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
660 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
661
662 @item @b{Missing Features}
663 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
664 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
665 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
666 enabled in OpenOCD.
667
668 @item @b{Scripts}
669 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
670 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
671 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
672
673 @item @b{Commands}
674 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
675 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
676 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
677 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
678
679 @item @b{Historical Note}
680 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
681 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
682 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
683 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
684
685 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
686 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
687 @end itemize
688
689 @node Running
690 @chapter Running
691 @cindex command line options
692 @cindex logfile
693 @cindex directory search
694
695 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
696 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
697 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
698 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
699 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
700 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
701 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
702
703 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
704 tell it how each debug session should work.
705 The @option{--help} option shows:
706 @verbatim
707 bash$ openocd --help
708
709 --help | -h display this help
710 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
711 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
712 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
713 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
714 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
715 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
716 --command | -c run <command>
717 @end verbatim
718
719 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
720 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
721 To specify one or more different
722 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
723
724 @example
725 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
726 @end example
727
728 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
729 @enumerate
730 @item the current directory,
731 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
732 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
733 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
734 @item @file{%APPDATA%/OpenOCD} (only on Windows),
735 @item @file{$HOME/Library/Preferences/org.openocd} (only on Darwin),
736 @item @file{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME/openocd} (@env{$XDG_CONFIG_HOME} defaults to @file{$HOME/.config}),
737 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd},
738 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
739 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
740 @end enumerate
741 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
742
743 @quotation Note
744 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
745 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
746 @end quotation
747
748 @section Simple setup, no customization
749
750 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
751 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
752 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
753 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
754 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
755
756 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
757 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
758 the server with some variation of one of the following:
759
760 @example
761 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
762 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
763 @end example
764
765 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
766 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
767 If all goes well you'll see output something like
768
769 @example
770 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
771 For bug reports, read
772 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
773 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
774 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
775 @end example
776
777 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
778 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
779 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
780
781 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
782
783 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
784 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
785 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
786 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
787 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
788 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
789 ensure that this always succeeds.
790 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
791 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
792 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
793 and then shut down without acting as a server.
794
795 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
796 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
797 those channels.
798
799 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
800 the @option{-d} option.
801
802 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
803 @option{-c} command line switch.
804
805 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
806 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
807 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
808 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
809 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
810 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
811 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
812
813 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
814 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
815
816 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
817 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
818 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
819 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
820
821 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
822 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
823
824 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
825 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
826 and start the OpenOCD server.
827 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
828 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
829 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
830 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
831
832 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
833
834 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
835 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
836 and a USB cable on the other.
837 Instead of USB, some dongles use Ethernet;
838 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
839
840 @enumerate
841 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
842 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
843 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
844 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
845 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
846 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
847 debugging host.
848
849 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
850 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
851 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
852 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
853 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
854
855 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
856 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
857 with 1.2 Volt boards.
858
859 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
860 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
861 ways to connect the cable.
862 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
863 Be sure it's firmly connected.
864
865 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
866 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
867 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
868 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
869 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
870 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
871 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
872 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
873
874 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
875 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
876 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
877 but are tedious to set up.
878 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
879 adapter signals to the right board pins.
880
881 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
882 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
883 you are using to run OpenOCD.
884 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
885
886 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
887 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
888 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
889 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
890
891 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
892 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
893 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
894
895 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
896 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
897 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
898 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
899
900 @end enumerate
901
902 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
903 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
904 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
905
906 @section Project Directory
907
908 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
909
910 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
911 single directory for your work with a given board.
912 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
913 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
914 files accessed through semihosting,
915 and for code you upload to the target board.
916 It is also the natural place to write files,
917 such as log files and data you download from the board.
918
919 @section Configuration Basics
920
921 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
922 a variety of ways you can mix them.
923 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
924
925 @itemize
926 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
927 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
928 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
929 @end itemize
930
931 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
932 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
933 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
934
935 @example
936 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
937
938 # GDB can also flash my flash!
939 gdb_memory_map enable
940 gdb_flash_program enable
941
942 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
943 @end example
944
945 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
946
947 @example
948 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
949 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
950 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
951 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
952 @end example
953
954 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
955 each supporting a different development task.
956 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
957 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
958
959 @quotation Important
960 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
961 problems with how it treats variables.
962 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
963 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
964 that can be tested in a later script.
965 @end quotation
966
967 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
968 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
969 to simplify your work.
970
971 @section User Config Files
972 @cindex config file, user
973 @cindex user config file
974 @cindex config file, overview
975
976 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
977 in one place.
978 One of the following will match your situation best:
979
980 @itemize
981 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
982 provided by someone else.
983 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
984 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
985 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
986 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
987 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
988 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
989
990 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
991 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
992
993 @enumerate
994 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
995 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
996 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
997 @end enumerate
998
999 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
1000 The first is an interface config file.
1001 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
1002 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
1003 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
1004 meet your deadline:
1005
1006 @example
1007 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
1008 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
1009 @end example
1010
1011 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
1012 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
1013 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
1014 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
1015
1016 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
1017 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
1018 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
1019 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
1020 target and board
1021 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
1022 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
1023
1024 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1025 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1026 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1027 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1028
1029 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1030 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1031 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1032 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1033 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1034
1035 @quotation Note
1036 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1037 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1038 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1039 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1040 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1041 @end quotation
1042
1043 @item
1044 You may need to write some C code.
1045 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1046 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1047 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1048 a new chip architecture.
1049 @end itemize
1050
1051 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1052 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1053 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1054
1055 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1056 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1057 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1058 @itemize
1059
1060 @item
1061 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1062 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1063 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1064 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1065
1066 @item
1067 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1068 @cindex vector_catch
1069 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1070 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1071 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1072 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1073 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1074 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1075
1076 @item
1077 You might need to override some defaults.
1078 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1079 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1080
1081 @item
1082 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1083 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1084 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1085 @end itemize
1086
1087 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1088
1089 A few project-specific utility
1090 routines may well speed up your work.
1091 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1092
1093 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1094 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1095 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1096 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1097 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1098 may help:
1099
1100 @example
1101 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1102 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1103 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1104 # Leave the CPU halted.
1105 reset init
1106
1107 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1108 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1109
1110 # Start running.
1111 resume 0x20000000
1112 @}
1113 @end example
1114
1115 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1116 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1117 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1118 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1119 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1120
1121 @example
1122 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1123 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1124 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1125 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1126 reset init
1127
1128 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1129 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1130 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1131 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1132 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1133 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1134 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1135
1136 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1137 reset run
1138 @}
1139 @end example
1140
1141 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1142 from NAND.
1143 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1144 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1145 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1146
1147 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1148 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1149
1150 @section Target Software Changes
1151
1152 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1153 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1154 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1155 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1156 handling issues like:
1157
1158 @itemize @bullet
1159
1160 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1161 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1162 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1163 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1164 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1165 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1166 your debug sessions.
1167
1168 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1169 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1170 That might however be your only option.
1171
1172 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1173 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1174 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1175 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1176 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1177 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1178 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1179 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1180 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1181 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1182 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1183 instead of the whole thing.
1184 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1185 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1186
1187 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1188 @cindex ARM semihosting
1189 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1190 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1191 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1192 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1193 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1194 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1195 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1196 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1197 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1198 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1199 NAND or SPI flash.
1200
1201 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1202 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1203 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1204 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1205 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1206
1207 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1208 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1209 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1210 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1211 registers which can be used to change various features including
1212 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1213 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1214 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1215 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1216 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1217
1218 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1219 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1220 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1221 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1222 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1223
1224 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1225 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1226 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1227 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1228 early code execution can be debugged
1229 or firmware can be replaced.
1230
1231 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1232 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1233 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1234 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1235 operations like writing to memory.)
1236
1237 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1238 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1239 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1240 various kinds of message.
1241 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1242
1243 @end itemize
1244
1245 @section Target Hardware Setup
1246
1247 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1248 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1249 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1250 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1251 working with.}
1252
1253 Common issues include:
1254
1255 @itemize @bullet
1256
1257 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1258 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1259 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1260 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1261 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1262 or one from a daughtercard).
1263 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1264 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1265
1266 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1267 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1268 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1269 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1270 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1271 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1272
1273 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1274 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1275 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1276 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1277 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1278
1279
1280 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1281 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1282 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1283 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1284 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1285 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1286 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1287
1288 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1289 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1290 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1291 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1292 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1293
1294 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1295 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1296 used to start booting.
1297
1298 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1299 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1300 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1301 multiple audio codec chips).
1302 This interacts with software
1303 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1304 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1305 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1306 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1307 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1308 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1309 audio or video codecs are used.
1310
1311 @end itemize
1312
1313 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1314 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1315 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1316 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1317 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1318 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1319 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1320 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1321 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1322 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1323
1324
1325 @node Config File Guidelines
1326 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1327
1328 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1329 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1330 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1331 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1332
1333 You should find the following directories under
1334 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1335 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1336 @itemize @bullet
1337 @item @file{interface} ...
1338 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1339 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1340 @item @file{board} ...
1341 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1342 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1343
1344 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1345 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1346 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1347 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1348 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1349 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1350 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1351 a CPU and an FPGA.
1352 @item @file{target} ...
1353 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1354 on a chip
1355 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1356 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1357 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1358 the target config file defines all of them.
1359 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1360 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1361 @end itemize
1362
1363 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1364 file may override features in any of the above files by
1365 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1366 commands specific to their situation.
1367
1368 @section Interface Config Files
1369
1370 The user config file
1371 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1372
1373 @example
1374 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1375 @end example
1376
1377 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1378 in use today with OpenOCD.
1379 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1380 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1381
1382 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1383 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1384 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1385 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1386 and need to provide a driver for it.
1387
1388 @section Board Config Files
1389 @cindex config file, board
1390 @cindex board config file
1391
1392 The user config file
1393 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1394
1395 @example
1396 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1397 @end example
1398
1399 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1400 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1401 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1402
1403 @enumerate
1404 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1405 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1406 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1407 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1408 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1409 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1410 @end enumerate
1411
1412 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1413 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1414 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1415 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1416
1417 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1418 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1419 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1420 configuration works.
1421
1422 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1423
1424 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1425 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1426 convention on how to use certain variables.
1427
1428 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1429 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1430 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1431 used at will within a target configuration file.
1432
1433 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1434 for a board with three chips:
1435
1436 @example
1437 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1438 set CHIPNAME network
1439 set ENDIAN big
1440 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1441 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1442 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1443 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1444
1445 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1446 set CHIPNAME video
1447 set ENDIAN little
1448 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1449 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1450 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1451 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1452
1453 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1454 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1455 unset ENDIAN
1456 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1457 @end example
1458
1459 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1460 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1461 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1462 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1463 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1464 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1465 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1466 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1467
1468 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1469 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1470 naming collisions.
1471
1472 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1473 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1474 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1475 up other clocks and peripherals.
1476
1477 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1478 @cindex variable names
1479
1480 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1481 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1482 one such chip (as shown above).
1483 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1484 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1485 to promote consistency and
1486 so that board files can override target defaults.
1487
1488 Inputs to target config files include:
1489
1490 @itemize @bullet
1491 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1492 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1493 tap identifier dotted names.
1494 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1495 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1496 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1497 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1498 Chips that can't change endianness don't need to use this variable.
1499 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1500 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1501 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1502 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1503 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1504 @end itemize
1505
1506 Outputs from target config files include:
1507
1508 @itemize @bullet
1509 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1510 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1511 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1512 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1513 specific to that board and that target.
1514 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1515 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1516 @end itemize
1517
1518 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1519 @cindex event, reset-init
1520 @cindex reset-init handler
1521
1522 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1523 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1524 fully set up yet.
1525 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1526 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1527 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1528 handler is one of the most important.
1529
1530 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1531 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1532 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1533 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1534 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1535
1536 @quotation Note
1537 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1538 are included here.
1539 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1540 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1541 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1542 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1543 @end quotation
1544
1545 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1546 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1547 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1548 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1549 those as parameters.
1550 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1551 and disabling the watchdog.
1552 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1553 the next developer doing such work.
1554 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1555
1556 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1557 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1558 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1559 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1560
1561 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1562
1563 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1564 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1565 a low JTAG clock rate.
1566 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1567 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1568 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1569 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1570 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1571 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1572 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1573
1574 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1575 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1576 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1577 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1578 which might be less than that.
1579
1580 @quotation Warning
1581 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1582 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1583 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1584 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1585 @end quotation
1586
1587 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1588 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1589 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1590 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter speed}.
1591 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1592 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1593
1594 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1595 @subsection The init_board procedure
1596 @cindex init_board procedure
1597
1598 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1599 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1600 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1601 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1602 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1603 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1604 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1605 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1606 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1607 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1608 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1609 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1610
1611 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1612 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1613
1614 @example
1615 ### board_file.cfg ###
1616
1617 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1618 source [find target/target.cfg]
1619
1620 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1621 # enables fast on-board clock source
1622 # configures the chip to use it
1623 @}
1624
1625 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1626 proc init_board @{@} @{
1627 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1628
1629 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1630 adapter speed 100
1631 @}
1632
1633 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1634 enable_fast_clock
1635 adapter speed 10000
1636 @}
1637 @}
1638 @end example
1639
1640 @section Target Config Files
1641 @cindex config file, target
1642 @cindex target config file
1643
1644 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1645 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1646 more target config files like this:
1647
1648 @example
1649 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1650 @end example
1651
1652 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1653 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1654 In summary the target files should contain
1655
1656 @enumerate
1657 @item Set defaults
1658 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1659 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1660 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1661 @item On-Chip flash
1662 @end enumerate
1663
1664 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1665 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1666 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1667
1668 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1669 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1670 can talk to the chip.
1671 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1672 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1673 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1674 and other processing engines.
1675
1676 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1677
1678 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1679 letting board config files express environment-specific
1680 differences in how things should be set up.
1681
1682 @example
1683 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1684 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1685 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1686 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1687 @} else @{
1688 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1689 @}
1690
1691 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1692 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1693 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1694 @} else @{
1695 set _ENDIAN little
1696 @}
1697
1698 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1699 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1700 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1701 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1702 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1703 @} else @{
1704 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1705 @}
1706 @end example
1707 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1708
1709 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1710 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1711 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1712
1713 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1714 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1715 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1716
1717 @example
1718 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1719 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1720 @end example
1721
1722 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1723 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1724 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1725 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1726 for taps.
1727
1728 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1729 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1730 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1731 looks (in part) like this:
1732
1733 @example
1734 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1735 @end example
1736
1737 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1738 to source such a config file twice, with different
1739 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1740 it adds a different TAP each time.
1741
1742 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1743 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1744 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1745 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1746
1747 @example
1748 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1749 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1750 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1751 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1752 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1753 @end example
1754
1755 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1756 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1757
1758 @itemize
1759 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1760 plus a JRC to enable them
1761 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1762 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1763 is not currently used)
1764 @end itemize
1765
1766 @subsection Add CPU targets
1767
1768 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1769 GDB and other commands can use it.
1770 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1771 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1772 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1773 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1774
1775 @example
1776 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1777 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1778 @end example
1779
1780 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1781 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1782 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1783 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1784 a work area if you can.
1785 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1786
1787 @example
1788 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1789 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1790 @end example
1791
1792 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1793 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1794 @cindex SMP
1795 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1796
1797 @example
1798 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1799 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1800 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1801 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1802 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1803 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1804 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1805 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1806 @end example
1807 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1808 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1809 @itemize @bullet
1810 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1811 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1812 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1813 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1814 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1815 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1816 @end itemize
1817
1818 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1819 command have been implemented.
1820 @itemize @bullet
1821 @item cortex_a smp on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1822 @item cortex_a smp off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1823 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1824 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1825 @item cortex_a smp : display current SMP mode.
1826 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1827 following example.
1828 @end itemize
1829
1830 @example
1831 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1832 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1833 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1834 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1835 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1836 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1837 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1838 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1839 > resume
1840 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1841 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1842 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1843 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1844 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1845 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1846 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1847 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1848 @end example
1849
1850
1851 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1852
1853 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1854 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1855 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1856
1857 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1858 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1859 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1860 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1861 both signals.
1862
1863 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1864 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1865 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1866 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1867 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1868 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1869 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1870 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1871 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1872 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1873 not available.)
1874
1875 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1876 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1877 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1878 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1879 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1880 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1881 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1882 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1883
1884 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1885 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1886 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1887 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1888 slower clock than they will use later.
1889 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1890 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1891 than they will use later.
1892 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1893
1894 @quotation Important
1895 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1896 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1897 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1898 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1899 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1900 @end quotation
1901
1902 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1903 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1904 @cindex init_targets procedure
1905
1906 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1907 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1908 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1909 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1910 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1911 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1912 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1913 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1914 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1915
1916 @example
1917 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1918
1919 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1920 # basic initialization procedure ...
1921 @}
1922
1923 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1924 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1925 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1926 @}
1927
1928 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1929
1930 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1931
1932 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1933 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1934 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1935 @}
1936 @end example
1937
1938 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1939 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1940
1941 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1942
1943 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1944 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1945
1946 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1947 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1948 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1949
1950 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1951 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1952 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1953 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1954 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1955 events already assigned.
1956
1957 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1958
1959 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1960 special high speed download features - enable it.
1961
1962 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1963
1964 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1965 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1966 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1967 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1968 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1969 If you are using an external trace port,
1970 configure it in your board config file.
1971 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1972 configure it in your target config file.
1973
1974 @example
1975 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1976 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1977 @end example
1978
1979 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1980
1981 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1982
1983 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1984 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1985 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1986 the TARGET (chip) file.
1987
1988 Examples:
1989 @itemize @bullet
1990 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1991 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1992 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1993 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1994 @end itemize
1995
1996 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1997 @section Translating Configuration Files
1998 @cindex translation
1999 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
2000 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
2001 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
2002 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
2003 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
2004 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
2005
2006 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
2007 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
2008 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
2009 convert other scripts later on.
2010
2011 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
2012 replace job:
2013
2014 @example
2015 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
2016 #
2017 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
2018 #
2019 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
2020 #
2021 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
2022
2023 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
2024 global TARGETNAME
2025
2026 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2027
2028 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2029 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2030 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2031 @}
2032 @end example
2033
2034
2035
2036 @node Server Configuration
2037 @chapter Server Configuration
2038 @cindex initialization
2039 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2040 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2041 supported.
2042
2043 @anchor{configurationstage}
2044 @section Configuration Stage
2045 @cindex configuration stage
2046 @cindex config command
2047
2048 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2049 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2050 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2051 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2052 inside startup scripts.
2053
2054 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2055 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2056 which may be issued interactively.
2057 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2058 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2059
2060 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2061 flash banks,
2062 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2063 and other basic setup.
2064 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2065 may access or activate TAPs.
2066 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2067 longer be issued.
2068
2069 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2070 @section Entering the Run Stage
2071
2072 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2073 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2074 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2075 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2076 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2077 You should see no errors at this point.
2078 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2079 commands you used to configure the server.
2080 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2081 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2082 on the scan chain.
2083
2084 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2085 become available.
2086 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2087 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2088 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2089 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2090 entry to the run stage.
2091
2092 @deffn {Config Command} init
2093 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2094 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2095 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2096 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2097 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2098 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2099
2100 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2101 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2102 configuration files and/or command line options.
2103
2104 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2105 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2106 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2107 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2108 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2109 @end deffn
2110
2111 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2112 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2113 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2114
2115 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2116 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2117 scan chain.
2118 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2119 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2120
2121 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2122 they return.
2123 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2124 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2125 @end deffn
2126
2127 @anchor{tcpipports}
2128 @section TCP/IP Ports
2129 @cindex TCP port
2130 @cindex server
2131 @cindex port
2132 @cindex security
2133 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2134 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2135 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2136
2137 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2138 access using one or more of these ports.
2139 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2140 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2141 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2142
2143 @anchor{gdb_port}
2144 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2145 @cindex GDB server
2146 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2147 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2148 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2149 the normal use cases.
2150
2151 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2152 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2153 disables the gdb server.
2154
2155 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2156 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2157
2158 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2159 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2160 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2161
2162 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2163 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2164 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2165 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2166 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2167 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2168 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2169 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2170 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2171
2172 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2173 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2174 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2175 @end deffn
2176
2177 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2178 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2179 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2180 output from the Tcl engine.
2181 Intended as a machine interface.
2182 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2183 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2184 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2185 @end deffn
2186
2187 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2188 Specify or query the
2189 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2190 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2191 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2192 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2193 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2194 @end deffn
2195
2196 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2197 @section GDB Configuration
2198 @cindex GDB
2199 @cindex GDB configuration
2200 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2201 The ones listed here are static and global.
2202 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2203 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2204
2205 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2206 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2207 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2208 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2209 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2210 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2211 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2215 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2216 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2217 vFlash packet is received.
2218 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2222 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2223 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2224 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2225 for flash programming to work.
2226 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2227 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2228 @end deffn
2229
2230 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2231 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2232 by GDB memory read packets.
2233 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2234 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2235 @end deffn
2236
2237 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2238 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2239 packets report errors or not.
2240 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2241 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2242 @end deffn
2243
2244 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2245 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2246 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2247 @end deffn
2248
2249 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2250 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2251
2252 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2253 @end deffn
2254
2255 @anchor{eventpolling}
2256 @section Event Polling
2257
2258 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2259 where significant events can happen at any time.
2260 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2261 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2262 or to GDB.
2263
2264 Examples of such events include:
2265
2266 @itemize
2267 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2268 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2269 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2270 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2271 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2272 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2273 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2274 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2275 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2276 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2277 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2278 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2279 @end itemize
2280
2281 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2282 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2283 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2284 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2285 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2286
2287 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2288 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2289 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2290 to the various active targets.
2291 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2292 which is normally done in the background.
2293
2294 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2295 Poll the current target for its current state.
2296 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2297 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2298 specific information about the current state is printed.
2299 An optional parameter
2300 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2301
2302 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2303 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2304 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2305 @example
2306 > poll
2307 background polling: on
2308 target state: halted
2309 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2310 current mode: Supervisor
2311 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2312 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2313 >
2314 @end example
2315 @end deffn
2316
2317 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2318 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2319 @cindex config file, interface
2320 @cindex interface config file
2321
2322 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2323 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2324 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2325
2326 @quotation Note
2327 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2328 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2329 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2330 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2331 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2332 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2333 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2334 @end quotation
2335
2336 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2337 through commands in an interface configuration
2338 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2339 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2340
2341 @example
2342 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2343 @end example
2344
2345 These commands tell
2346 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2347 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2348
2349 @example
2350 # jlink interface
2351 adapter driver jlink
2352 @end example
2353
2354 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2355
2356
2357 @section Adapter Configuration
2358
2359 The @command{adapter driver} command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2360 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2361 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2362
2363 @deffn {Config Command} {adapter driver} name
2364 Use the adapter driver @var{name} to connect to the
2365 target.
2366 @end deffn
2367
2368 @deffn Command {adapter list}
2369 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2370 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2371 @end deffn
2372 @deffn Command {adapter transports} transport_name+
2373 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2374 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2375 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2376 the hardware can support.
2377 @end deffn
2378
2379
2380
2381 @deffn Command {adapter name}
2382 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2383 @end deffn
2384
2385 @anchor{adapter_usb_location}
2386 @deffn Command {adapter usb location} [<bus>-<port>[.<port>]...]
2387 Displays or specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2388 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2389 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2390 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2391 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t} or @emph{dmesg}.
2392
2393 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2394 @end deffn
2395
2396 @section Interface Drivers
2397
2398 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2399 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2400 available at run time.
2401
2402 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2403 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2404 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2405 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2406
2407 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2408 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2409 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2410 @end deffn
2411
2412 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2413 Displays status of RTCK option.
2414 Optionally sets that option first.
2415 @end deffn
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2419 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2420 This has one driver-specific command:
2421
2422 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2423 Logs some status
2424 @end deffn
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2428 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2429 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2430 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2431 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2432 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2433 @end deffn
2434
2435 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2436 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter v1 (USB HID based)
2437 or v2 (USB bulk).
2438
2439 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2440 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2441 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2442 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2443 @example
2444 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2445 @end example
2446 @end deffn
2447
2448 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2449 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2450 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2451 @end deffn
2452
2453 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_backend} [@option{auto}|@option{usb_bulk}|@option{hid}]
2454 Specifies how to communicate with the adapter:
2455
2456 @itemize @minus
2457 @item @option{hid} Use HID generic reports - CMSIS-DAP v1
2458 @item @option{usb_bulk} Use USB bulk - CMSIS-DAP v2
2459 @item @option{auto} First try USB bulk CMSIS-DAP v2, if not found try HID CMSIS-DAP v1.
2460 This is the default if @command{cmsis_dap_backend} is not specified.
2461 @end itemize
2462 @end deffn
2463
2464 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_usb interface} [number]
2465 Specifies the @var{number} of the USB interface to use in v2 mode (USB bulk).
2466 In most cases need not to be specified and interfaces are searched by
2467 interface string or for user class interface.
2468 @end deffn
2469
2470 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2471 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2472 @end deffn
2473 @end deffn
2474
2475 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2476 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2480 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2481 @end deffn
2482
2483 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2484 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2485 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2486
2487 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2488 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2489
2490 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2491 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2492
2493 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2494 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2495 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2496 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2497 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2498 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2499
2500 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2501 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2502 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2503 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2504 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2505
2506 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2507 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2508 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2509 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2510
2511 @itemize @minus
2512 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2513 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2514 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2515 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2516 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2517 switching data and direction as necessary
2518 @end itemize
2519
2520 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2521 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2522
2523 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2524 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2525 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2526 @example
2527 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2528 @end example
2529 @end deffn
2530
2531 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2532 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2533 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2534 during device selection.
2535 @end deffn
2536
2537 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2538 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2539 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2540 is connected to the host.
2541 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2542 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2543 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2544 @end deffn
2545
2546 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>-<port>[.<port>]...
2547 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
2548 Use the command @ref{adapter_usb_location,,adapter usb location} instead.}
2549
2550 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2551 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2552 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2553 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2554 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2555
2556 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2557 @end deffn
2558
2559 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2560 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2561 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2562 @end deffn
2563
2564 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2565 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2566 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2567 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2568 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2569 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2570 and initially asserted reset signals.
2571 @end deffn
2572
2573 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2574 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2575 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2576 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2577 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2578 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2579 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2580 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2581 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2582 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2583 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2584
2585 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2586 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2587 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2588 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2589 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2590 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2591
2592 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2593 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2594 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2595 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2596 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2597 are always driven by the FTDI.
2598
2599 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2600 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2601 @var{name}.
2602 @end deffn
2603
2604 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2605 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2606 @itemize @minus
2607 @item @option{0}, drive low
2608 @item @option{1}, drive high
2609 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2610 @end itemize
2611 @end deffn
2612
2613 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2614 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2615 @end deffn
2616
2617 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2618 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2619
2620 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2621 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2622 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2623 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2624 @itemize @minus
2625 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2626 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2627 @end itemize
2628 @end deffn
2629
2630 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2631 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2632
2633 @end deffn
2634
2635 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2636 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R,
2637 FT230X, FT231X and similar USB UART bridge ICs by reusing RS232 signals as GPIO.
2638 It currently doesn't support using CBUS pins as GPIO.
2639
2640 List of connections (default physical pin numbers for FT232R in 28-pin SSOP package):
2641 @itemize @minus
2642 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2643 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2644 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2645 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2646 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2647 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2648 @end itemize
2649
2650 User can change default pinout by supplying configuration
2651 commands with GPIO numbers or RS232 signal names.
2652 GPIO numbers correspond to bit numbers in FTDI GPIO register.
2653 They differ from physical pin numbers.
2654 For details see actual FTDI chip datasheets.
2655 Every JTAG line must be configured to unique GPIO number
2656 different than any other JTAG line, even those lines
2657 that are sometimes not used like TRST or SRST.
2658
2659 FT232R
2660 @itemize @minus
2661 @item bit 7 - RI
2662 @item bit 6 - DCD
2663 @item bit 5 - DSR
2664 @item bit 4 - DTR
2665 @item bit 3 - CTS
2666 @item bit 2 - RTS
2667 @item bit 1 - RXD
2668 @item bit 0 - TXD
2669 @end itemize
2670
2671 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2672 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2673
2674 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2675 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2676 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2677 @end deffn
2678
2679 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2680 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2681 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2682 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2683 @end deffn
2684
2685 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_jtag_nums} @var{tck} @var{tms} @var{tdi} @var{tdo}
2686 Set four JTAG GPIO numbers at once.
2687 If not specified, default 0 3 1 2 or TXD CTS RXD RTS is used.
2688 @end deffn
2689
2690 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tck_num} @var{tck}
2691 Set TCK GPIO number. If not specified, default 0 or TXD is used.
2692 @end deffn
2693
2694 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tms_num} @var{tms}
2695 Set TMS GPIO number. If not specified, default 3 or CTS is used.
2696 @end deffn
2697
2698 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdi_num} @var{tdi}
2699 Set TDI GPIO number. If not specified, default 1 or RXD is used.
2700 @end deffn
2701
2702 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_tdo_num} @var{tdo}
2703 Set TDO GPIO number. If not specified, default 2 or RTS is used.
2704 @end deffn
2705
2706 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_trst_num} @var{trst}
2707 Set TRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 4 or DTR is used.
2708 @end deffn
2709
2710 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_srst_num} @var{srst}
2711 Set SRST GPIO number. If not specified, default 6 or DCD is used.
2712 @end deffn
2713
2714 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_restore_serial} @var{word}
2715 Restore serial port after JTAG. This USB bitmode control word
2716 (16-bit) will be sent before quit. Lower byte should
2717 set GPIO direction register to a "sane" state:
2718 0x15 for TXD RTS DTR as outputs (1), others as inputs (0). Higher
2719 byte is usually 0 to disable bitbang mode.
2720 When kernel driver reattaches, serial port should continue to work.
2721 Value 0xFFFF disables sending control word and serial port,
2722 then kernel driver will not reattach.
2723 If not specified, default 0xFFFF is used.
2724 @end deffn
2725
2726 @end deffn
2727
2728 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2729 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2730 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2731 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2732
2733 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2734 processors which are being simulated.
2735
2736 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2737 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2738 sockets instead of TCP.
2739 @end deffn
2740
2741 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2742 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2743 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2744 @end deffn
2745
2746 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2747 something like:
2748
2749 @example
2750 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2751 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2752 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2753 @end example
2754
2755 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2756 named mysocket:
2757
2758 @example
2759 adapter driver remote_bitbang
2760 remote_bitbang_port 0
2761 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2762 @end example
2763 @end deffn
2764
2765 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2766 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2767 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2768 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2769
2770 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2771 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2772 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2773 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2774 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2775 @end deffn
2776
2777 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2778 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2779 default values are used.
2780 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2781 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2782 @example
2783 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2784 @end example
2785 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2786 @example
2787 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2788 @end example
2789 @end deffn
2790
2791 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2792 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2793 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2794 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2795 target board.
2796
2797 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2798 @example
2799 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2800 reset_config srst_only
2801 @end example
2802 @end deffn
2803
2804 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2805 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2806 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2807 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2808 @end deffn
2809
2810 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2811 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2812 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2813 @end deffn
2814
2815 @end deffn
2816
2817 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2818 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2819 This has one driver-specific command:
2820
2821 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2822 Display either the address of the I/O port
2823 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2824 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2825 This is a write-once setting.
2826 @end deffn
2827 @end deffn
2828
2829 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2830 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2831 transports.
2832
2833 @quotation Compatibility Note
2834 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2835 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2836 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2837 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2838 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2839 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2840 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2841 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2842 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2843 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2844 @end quotation
2845
2846 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2847 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2848 states.
2849 @end deffn
2850 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2851 Display free device internal memory.
2852 @end deffn
2853 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2854 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2855 command version.
2856 @end deffn
2857 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2858 Display the device configuration.
2859 @end deffn
2860 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2861 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2862 power state.
2863 @end deffn
2864 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2865 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2866 @end deffn
2867 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2868 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2869 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2870 IP configuration.
2871 @end deffn
2872 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2873 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2874 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2875 @end deffn
2876 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2877 Reset the current configuration.
2878 @end deffn
2879 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2880 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2881 @end deffn
2882 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2883 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2884 pairs.
2885
2886 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2887 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2888 @example
2889 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2890 @end example
2891 @end deffn
2892 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2893 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2894 pairs.
2895
2896 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2897 @example
2898 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2899 77a90000
2900 @end example
2901 @end deffn
2902 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2903 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2904 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2905 selection via USB address is not always unambiguous. It is recommended to use
2906 the serial number instead, if possible.
2907
2908 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2909 @end deffn
2910 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2911 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2912 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2913
2914 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2915 @end deffn
2916 @end deffn
2917
2918 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2919 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2920 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2921 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2922 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2923 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2924 configuration script.
2925
2926 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2927 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2928 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2929 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2930 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2931
2932 Known limitations:
2933 @itemize @bullet
2934 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2935 and 2.7 MHz.
2936 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2937 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2938 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2939 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2940 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2941 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2942 communications with the target.
2943 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2944 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2945 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2946 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2947 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2948 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2949 @end itemize
2950
2951 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2952 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2953 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2954 @end deffn
2955
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2957 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2958 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2962 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2963 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2964 target as a side-effect.
2965 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2966 @end deffn
2967
2968 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2969 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2970 version, and target voltage.
2971 @end deffn
2972 @end deffn
2973
2974 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2975 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2976 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2977 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2978 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2979
2980 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2981 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2982 This is a write-once setting.
2983 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2984
2985 @itemize @minus
2986 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2987 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2988 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2989 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2990 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2991 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2992 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2993 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2994 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2995 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2996 some versions of
2997 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2998 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2999 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
3000 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
3001 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
3002 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
3003 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
3004 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
3005 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
3006 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
3007 @end itemize
3008 @end deffn
3009
3010 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
3011 Display either the address of the I/O port
3012 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
3013 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
3014 This is a write-once setting.
3015
3016 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
3017 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
3018 you may encounter a problem.
3019 @end deffn
3020
3021 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
3022 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
3023 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
3024 @command{adapter speed} configuration.
3025 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
3026 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
3027
3028 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
3029 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
3030 @quotation Tip
3031 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
3032 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
3033 @example
3034 > parport_toggling_time 1000
3035 > adapter speed 500
3036 @end example
3037 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
3038 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
3039 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
3040 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
3041 large set of samples.
3042 Update the setting to match your measurement:
3043 @example
3044 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
3045 @end example
3046 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter speed}
3047 command given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
3048
3049 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
3050 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
3051 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
3052 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
3053 match with the rate you specified in the @command{adapter speed} command;
3054 be conservative.
3055 @end quotation
3056 @end deffn
3057
3058 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
3059 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
3060 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
3061 @end deffn
3062
3063 For example, the interface configuration file for a
3064 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
3065
3066 @example
3067 adapter driver parport
3068 parport_port 0x278
3069 parport_cable wiggler
3070 @end example
3071 @end deffn
3072
3073 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
3074 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
3075 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
3076 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
3077 @end deffn
3078 @end deffn
3079
3080 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
3081 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
3082 @end deffn
3083
3084 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
3085 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3086 @end deffn
3087
3088 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
3089 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
3090
3091 @quotation Note
3092 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
3093 which are not currently documented here.
3094 @end quotation
3095 @end deffn
3096
3097 @anchor{hla_interface}
3098 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
3099 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
3100 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
3101 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
3102
3103 Currently supported adapters include the STMicroelectronics ST-LINK, TI ICDI
3104 and Nuvoton Nu-Link.
3105 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
3106 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
3107 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
3108 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
3109
3110 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
3111 Currently Not Supported.
3112 @end deffn
3113
3114 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
3115 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3116 @end deffn
3117
3118 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi}|@option{nulink})
3119 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3120 @end deffn
3121
3122 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3123 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3124 @end deffn
3125
3126 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_stlink_backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3127 @emph{ST-Link only:} Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3128 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3129
3130 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3131 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3132 ST-LINK server software module}.
3133 @end deffn
3134
3135 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3136 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3137 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3138 @end deffn
3139 @end deffn
3140
3141 @anchor{st_link_dap_interface}
3142 @deffn {Interface Driver} {st-link}
3143 This is a driver that supports STMicroelectronics adapters ST-LINK/V2
3144 (from firmware V2J24) and STLINK-V3, thanks to a new API that provides
3145 directly access the arm ADIv5 DAP.
3146
3147 The new API provide access to multiple AP on the same DAP, but the
3148 maximum number of the AP port is limited by the specific firmware version
3149 (e.g. firmware V2J29 has 3 as maximum AP number, while V2J32 has 8).
3150 An error is returned for any AP number above the maximum allowed value.
3151
3152 @emph{Note:} Either these same adapters and their older versions are
3153 also supported by @ref{hla_interface, the hla interface driver}.
3154
3155 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link backend} (usb | tcp [port])
3156 Choose between 'exclusive' USB communication (the default backend) or
3157 'shared' mode using ST-Link TCP server (the default port is 7184).
3158
3159 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server is a binary application provided by ST
3160 available from @url{https://www.st.com/en/development-tools/st-link-server.html,
3161 ST-LINK server software module}.
3162
3163 @emph{Note:} ST-Link TCP server does not support the SWIM transport.
3164 @end deffn
3165
3166 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link serial} serial
3167 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
3168 @end deffn
3169
3170 @deffn {Config Command} {st-link vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3171 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3172 @end deffn
3173 @end deffn
3174
3175 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3176 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3177 @end deffn
3178
3179 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3180 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3181 @end deffn
3182
3183 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xds110}
3184 The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
3185 LaunchPad evaluation boards. The XDS110 is also available as a stand-alone USB
3186 debug probe with the added capability to supply power to the target board. The
3187 following commands are supported by the XDS110 driver:
3188
3189 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 serial} serial_string
3190 Specifies the serial number of which XDS110 probe to use. Otherwise, the first
3191 XDS110 found will be used.
3192 @end deffn
3193
3194 @deffn {Config Command} {xds110 supply} voltage_in_millivolts
3195 Available only on the XDS110 stand-alone probe. Sets the voltage level of the
3196 XDS110 power supply. A value of 0 leaves the supply off. Otherwise, the supply
3197 can be set to any value in the range 1800 to 3600 millivolts.
3198 @end deffn
3199
3200 @deffn {Command} {xds110 info}
3201 Displays information about the connected XDS110 debug probe (e.g. firmware
3202 version).
3203 @end deffn
3204 @end deffn
3205
3206 @deffn {Interface Driver} {xlnx_pcie_xvc}
3207 This driver supports the Xilinx Virtual Cable (XVC) over PCI Express.
3208 It is commonly found in Xilinx based PCI Express designs. It allows debugging
3209 fabric based JTAG/SWD devices such as Cortex-M1/M3 microcontrollers. Access to this is
3210 exposed via extended capability registers in the PCI Express configuration space.
3211
3212 For more information see Xilinx PG245 (Section on From_PCIE_to_JTAG mode).
3213
3214 @deffn {Config Command} {xlnx_pcie_xvc_config} device
3215 Specifies the PCI Express device via parameter @var{device} to use.
3216
3217 The correct value for @var{device} can be obtained by looking at the output
3218 of lscpi -D (first column) for the corresponding device.
3219
3220 The string will be of the format "DDDD:BB:SS.F" such as "0000:65:00.1".
3221
3222 @end deffn
3223 @end deffn
3224
3225 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3226 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3227 @end deffn
3228
3229 @quotation Note
3230 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3231 which are not currently documented here.
3232 @end quotation
3233
3234 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3235 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3236 No arguments: print status.
3237 @end deffn
3238
3239 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3240 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3241 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3242
3243 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3244 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3245 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3246 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3247 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3248 configuration on exit.
3249
3250 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3251 pinout.
3252
3253 @end deffn
3254
3255 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3256 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3257 of the one which is most popular.
3258
3259 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3260
3261 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3262 pinout.
3263
3264 @end deffn
3265
3266
3267 @deffn {Interface Driver} {linuxgpiod}
3268 Linux provides userspace access to GPIO through libgpiod since Linux kernel version v4.6.
3269 The driver emulates either JTAG and SWD transport through bitbanging.
3270
3271 See @file{interface/dln-2-gpiod.cfg} for a sample config.
3272 @end deffn
3273
3274
3275 @deffn {Interface Driver} {sysfsgpio}
3276 Linux legacy userspace access to GPIO through sysfs is deprecated from Linux kernel version v5.3.
3277 Prefer using @b{linuxgpiod}, instead.
3278
3279 See @file{interface/sysfsgpio-raspberrypi.cfg} for a sample config.
3280 @end deffn
3281
3282
3283 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3284 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3285 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3286
3287 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3288 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3289 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3290
3291 @itemize @minus
3292 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3293 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3294 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3295 @end itemize
3296 @end deffn
3297
3298 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3299 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3300 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3301 @end deffn
3302 @end deffn
3303
3304
3305 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jtag_dpi}
3306 SystemVerilog Direct Programming Interface (DPI) compatible driver for
3307 JTAG devices in emulation. The driver acts as a client for the SystemVerilog
3308 DPI server interface.
3309
3310 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_port} port
3311 Specifies the TCP/IP port number of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3312 @end deffn
3313
3314 @deffn {Config Command} {jtag_dpi_set_address} address
3315 Specifies the TCP/IP address of the SystemVerilog DPI server interface.
3316 @end deffn
3317 @end deffn
3318
3319
3320 @section Transport Configuration
3321 @cindex Transport
3322 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3323 and the debug adapter you are using,
3324 several transports may be available to
3325 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3326 @deffn Command {transport list}
3327 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3328 version of OpenOCD.
3329 @end deffn
3330
3331 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3332 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3333
3334 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3335 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3336 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3337 adapter's driver).
3338
3339 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3340 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3341 supported by the debug adapter.
3342
3343 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3344 transport, if any.
3345 @end deffn
3346
3347 @subsection JTAG Transport
3348 @cindex JTAG
3349 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3350 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3351 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3352 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3353 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3354 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3355
3356 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3357 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3358 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_jtag})
3359 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3360 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_jtag}).
3361
3362 @subsection SWD Transport
3363 @cindex SWD
3364 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3365 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3366 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3367 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3368 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3369 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3370 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3371
3372 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3373 swd}. Unless your adapter uses either @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3374 driver} (in which case the command is @command{transport select hla_swd})
3375 or @ref{st_link_dap_interface,the st-link interface driver} (in which case
3376 the command is @command{transport select dapdirect_swd}).
3377
3378 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3379 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3380 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3381 expected to change.
3382 @end deffn
3383 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3384 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3385 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3386 No parameters: displays current settings.
3387 @end deffn
3388
3389 @subsection SPI Transport
3390 @cindex SPI
3391 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3392 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3393 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3394 solution for flash programming.
3395
3396 @anchor{swimtransport}
3397 @subsection SWIM Transport
3398 @cindex SWIM
3399 @cindex Single Wire Interface Module
3400 The Single Wire Interface Module (SWIM) is a low-pin-count debug protocol used
3401 by the STMicroelectronics MCU family STM8 and documented in the
3402 @uref{https://www.st.com/resource/en/user_manual/cd00173911.pdf, User Manual UM470}.
3403
3404 SWIM does not support boundary scan testing nor multiple cores.
3405
3406 The SWIM transport is selected with the command @command{transport select swim}.
3407
3408 The concept of TAPs does not fit in the protocol since SWIM does not implement
3409 a scan chain. Nevertheless, the current SW model of OpenOCD requires defining a
3410 virtual SWIM TAP through the command @command{swim newtap basename tap_type}.
3411 The TAP definition must precede the target definition command
3412 @command{target create target_name stm8 -chain-position basename.tap_type}.
3413
3414 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3415 @section JTAG Speed
3416 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3417 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3418 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3419 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3420 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3421 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3422 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3423 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3424 power management software that may be active.
3425
3426 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3427 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3428 target event handler.
3429 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3430 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3431 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3432 sets up those clocks).
3433 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3434 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3435 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3436 in the target config file.
3437 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3438 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3439 config file instead.
3440 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3441 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3442 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3443
3444 @example
3445 jtag_rclk 3000
3446 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3447 @end example
3448
3449 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3450 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3451 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3452 may not be the fastest solution.
3453
3454 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3455 instead of @command{adapter speed}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3456 which support adaptive clocking.
3457
3458 @deffn {Command} adapter speed max_speed_kHz
3459 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3460 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3461 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3462 than the speed specified.
3463
3464 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3465 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3466 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3467 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3468
3469 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3470 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3471 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3472 JTAG clocking after setup.
3473 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3474 If the interface device can not
3475 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3476 @end deffn
3477
3478 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3479 @cindex adaptive clocking
3480 @cindex RTCK
3481 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3482 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3483 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3484 @example
3485 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3486 jtag_rclk 3000
3487 @end example
3488 @end defun
3489
3490 @node Reset Configuration
3491 @chapter Reset Configuration
3492 @cindex Reset Configuration
3493
3494 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3495 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3496 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3497 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3498 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3499 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3500 Please see the various board files for examples.
3501
3502 @quotation Note
3503 To maintainers and integrators:
3504 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3505 Normally the board configuration file
3506 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3507 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3508
3509 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3510 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3511 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3512 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3513 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3514 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3515 @end quotation
3516
3517 @section Types of Reset
3518
3519 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3520 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3521 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3522
3523 @itemize @bullet
3524 @item
3525 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3526 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3527 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3528 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3529 @item
3530 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3531 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3532 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3533 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3534 @item
3535 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3536 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3537 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3538 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3539 @item
3540 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3541 several other types of reset.
3542 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3543 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3544 There may be individual module resets.
3545 @end itemize
3546
3547 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3548 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3549 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3550 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3551 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3552 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3553 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3554 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3555 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3556
3557 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3558 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3559
3560 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3561 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3562 common issues are:
3563
3564 @itemize @bullet
3565
3566 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3567 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3568 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3569 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3570 when either of those signals is not connected.
3571 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3572 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3573 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3574 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3575
3576 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3577 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3578 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3579 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3580
3581 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3582 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3583 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3584 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3585 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3586 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3587 hardware debouncing.
3588 Use the @command{adapter srst delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3589 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3590
3591 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3592 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3593 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3594 to use push/pull output drivers.
3595 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3596 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3597 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3598 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3599
3600 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3601 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3602 issues (not limited to errata).
3603 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3604 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3605 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3606 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3607 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3608 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3609 @end itemize
3610
3611 There can also be other issues.
3612 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3613 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3614 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3615 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3616 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3617 Agreement (NDA).
3618
3619 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3620 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3621 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3622
3623 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3624 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3625
3626 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3627
3628 @deffn {Command} adapter srst pulse_width milliseconds
3629 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3630 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3631 allowing it to be deasserted.
3632 @end deffn
3633
3634 @deffn {Command} adapter srst delay milliseconds
3635 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3636 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3637 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3638 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3639 @end deffn
3640
3641 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3642 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3643 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3644 allowing it to be deasserted.
3645 @end deffn
3646
3647 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3648 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3649 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3650 @end deffn
3651
3652 @anchor{reset_config}
3653 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3654 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3655 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3656 configuration scripts.
3657
3658 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3659 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3660 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3661 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3662 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3663 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3664 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3665 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3666
3667 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3668 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3669 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3670 -- may be specified at a time.
3671 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3672 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3673 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3674 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3675 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3676
3677 @itemize
3678 @item
3679 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3680 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3681 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3682 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3683 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3684
3685 @quotation Tip
3686 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3687 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3688 @end quotation
3689
3690 @item
3691 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3692 signal implementations.
3693 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3694 indicating everything behaves normally.
3695 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3696 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3697 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3698 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3699 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3700 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3701 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3702
3703 @item
3704 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3705 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3706 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3707 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3708 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3709 while SRST is asserted.
3710 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3711 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3712
3713 @item
3714 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3715 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3716 is required to use this option.
3717 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3718 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3719 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3720 be asserted before any target connection.
3721 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3722 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3723 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3724 @end itemize
3725
3726 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3727 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3728 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3729 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3730 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3731
3732 @itemize
3733 @item
3734 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3735 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3736 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3737 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3738
3739 @item
3740 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3741 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3742 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3743 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3744 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3745 @end itemize
3746 @end deffn
3747
3748 @section Custom Reset Handling
3749 @cindex events
3750
3751 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3752 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3753 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3754 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3755 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3756 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3757
3758 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3759 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3760 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3761 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3762 want to reset everything at once.
3763
3764 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3765 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3766 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3767 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3768 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3769 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3770 needs special attention.
3771
3772 Experiment with lower level operations, such as
3773 @command{adapter assert}, @command{adapter deassert}
3774 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3775 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3776 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3777 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3778 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3779 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3780 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3781
3782 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3783 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3784 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3785 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3786 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3787
3788 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3789 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3790 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3791 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3792 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3793 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3794 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3795 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3796 or potentially some other value.
3797
3798 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3799 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3800 operations such as @command{adapter assert} and @command{adapter deassert}.
3801 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3802 (or their associated targets)
3803 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3804
3805 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3806 they return.
3807 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3808 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3809 @end deffn
3810
3811 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3812 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3813 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3814 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3815 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3816 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3817 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3818 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3819 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3820 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3821 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3822 @end deffn
3823
3824 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3825 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3826 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3827 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3828 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3829 @end deffn
3830
3831
3832 @node TAP Declaration
3833 @chapter TAP Declaration
3834 @cindex TAP declaration
3835 @cindex TAP configuration
3836
3837 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3838 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3839
3840 @itemize @bullet
3841 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3842 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3843 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3844 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3845 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3846 start running that code.
3847 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3848 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3849 and missing connections.
3850 @end itemize
3851
3852 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3853 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3854 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3855 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3856 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3857
3858 @section Scan Chains
3859 @cindex scan chain
3860
3861 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3862 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3863 They also need to be added to
3864 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3865 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3866 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3867 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3868 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3869 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3870 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3871 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3872
3873 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3874 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3875 command, presented in the next chapter.
3876 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3877 debugging targets.)
3878 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3879
3880 @verbatim
3881 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3882 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3883 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3884 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3885 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3886 @end verbatim
3887
3888 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3889 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3890 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3891 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3892 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3893 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3894 until they are told to do so.
3895
3896 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3897 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3898 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3899 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3900
3901 @example
3902 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3903 @end example
3904
3905 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3906 by a given chip.
3907 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3908 and so forth.
3909 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3910 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3911 both inside a single chip and between them.
3912 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3913
3914 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3915 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3916 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3917 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3918 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3919 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3920 includes commands something like this:
3921
3922 @example
3923 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3924 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3925 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3926 @end example
3927
3928 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3929 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3930 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3931
3932 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3933 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3934 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3935 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3936 @example
3937 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3938 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3939 @}
3940 @end example
3941 @end deffn
3942
3943 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3944 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3945 and their status.
3946 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3947 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3948 but systems with a JTAG router can
3949 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3950 @end deffn
3951
3952 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3953 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3954
3955 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3956 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3957
3958 @section TAP Names
3959 @cindex dotted name
3960
3961 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3962 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3963 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3964 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3965 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3966 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3967 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3968 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3969
3970 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3971 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3972 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3973
3974 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3975
3976 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3977 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3978 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3979 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3980
3981 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3982 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3983 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3984 overridable.
3985
3986 @cindex TAP naming convention
3987 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3988 and should follow this convention:
3989
3990 @itemize @bullet
3991 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3992 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3993 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3994 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3995 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3996 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3997 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3998 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3999 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
4000 with a single TAP;
4001 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
4002 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
4003 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
4004 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
4005 @end itemize
4006
4007 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
4008
4009 @itemize @bullet
4010 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
4011 @*The length in bits of the
4012 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
4013 @end itemize
4014
4015 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4016
4017 @itemize @bullet
4018 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
4019 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
4020 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
4021 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
4022 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
4023 (the TAP is linked in).
4024 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
4025 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
4026 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
4027 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
4028 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
4029 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
4030 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
4031 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
4032 values that were found but not included in the list.
4033
4034 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
4035 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
4036 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
4037 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
4038 hardware to find these values.
4039 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
4040 @item @code{-ignore-version}
4041 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
4042 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
4043 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
4044 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
4045 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
4046 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
4047 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
4048 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
4049 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
4050 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
4051 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
4052 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
4053 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
4054 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
4055 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
4056 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
4057 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
4058 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
4059 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4060 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4061 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4062 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4063 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4064 @end itemize
4065 @end deffn
4066
4067 @section Other TAP commands
4068
4069 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-idcode}
4070 Get the value of the IDCODE found in hardware.
4071 @end deffn
4072
4073 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
4074 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
4075 At this writing this TAP attribute
4076 mechanism is limited and used mostly for event handling.
4077 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
4078 mechanism for debugger targets.)
4079 See the next section for information about the available events.
4080
4081 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
4082 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
4083 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
4084 @end deffn
4085
4086 @section TAP Events
4087 @cindex events
4088 @cindex TAP events
4089
4090 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
4091 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
4092 The other applies to debugger targets,
4093 which are associated with certain TAPs.
4094
4095 The TAP events currently defined are:
4096
4097 @itemize @bullet
4098 @item @b{post-reset}
4099 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
4100 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
4101 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
4102 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
4103 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
4104
4105 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
4106 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
4107 of any particular target.
4108 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
4109 @item @b{setup}
4110 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
4111 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
4112 @item @b{tap-disable}
4113 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
4114 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
4115 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4116 @item @b{tap-enable}
4117 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
4118 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
4119 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
4120 @end itemize
4121
4122 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
4123 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
4124 contents to be accurate), you might:
4125
4126 @example
4127 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
4128 echo "JTAG Reset done"
4129 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
4130 @}
4131 @end example
4132
4133
4134 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
4135 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
4136 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
4137 @cindex jrc
4138
4139 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
4140 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
4141 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
4142 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
4143 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
4144
4145 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
4146 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
4147 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
4148 be visible.
4149 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
4150 ignores, such as:
4151
4152 @itemize
4153 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
4154 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
4155 TAPs receive new instructions.
4156 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
4157 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
4158 @end itemize
4159
4160 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
4161 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
4162 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
4163 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
4164
4165 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
4166 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
4167
4168 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
4169 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
4170 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
4171 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
4172 should define TAP event handlers using
4173 code that looks something like this:
4174
4175 @example
4176 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
4177 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4178 @}
4179 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
4180 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
4181 @}
4182 @end example
4183
4184 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
4185
4186 @example
4187 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
4188 @end example
4189
4190 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
4191 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
4192 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
4193 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
4194
4195 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
4196 If necessary, disables the tap
4197 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
4198 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4199 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4200 and "0" if it is disabled.
4201 @end deffn
4202
4203 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
4204 If necessary, enables the tap
4205 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
4206 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4207 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4208 and "0" if it is disabled.
4209 @end deffn
4210
4211 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
4212 Returns the string "1" if the tap
4213 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
4214 and "0" if it is disabled.
4215
4216 @quotation Note
4217 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
4218 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
4219 @end quotation
4220 @end deffn
4221
4222 @anchor{autoprobing}
4223 @section Autoprobing
4224 @cindex autoprobe
4225 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
4226
4227 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
4228 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
4229 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
4230 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
4231
4232 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
4233 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
4234 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
4235 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
4236 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
4237 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
4238 right when they come out of reset).
4239
4240 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
4241
4242 @example
4243 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
4244 reset_config trst_and_srst
4245 jtag_rclk 8
4246 @end example
4247
4248 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
4249 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
4250
4251 @enumerate
4252 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
4253 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
4254 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
4255 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
4256 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
4257 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
4258 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
4259 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
4260 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
4261 that is discovered.
4262 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4263 register, it will report it.
4264 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4265 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4266 @end enumerate
4267
4268 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4269 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4270 that's a bit more complex:
4271
4272 @example
4273 clock speed 8 kHz
4274 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4275 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4276 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4277 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4278 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4279 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4280 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4281 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4282 @end example
4283
4284 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4285 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4286 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4287 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4288 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4289 and so forth.
4290
4291 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4292 @section DAP declaration (ARMv6-M, ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4293 @cindex DAP declaration
4294
4295 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4296 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4297 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all ARMv6-M, ARMv7
4298 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4299 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4300
4301 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4302
4303 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4304 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4305 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4306 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4307 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4308
4309 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4310
4311 @itemize @bullet
4312 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4313 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4314 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4315 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4316 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4317 @end itemize
4318 @end deffn
4319
4320 @deffn Command {dap names}
4321 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4322 for TCL scripting.
4323 @end deffn
4324
4325 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4326 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4327 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4328 @end deffn
4329
4330 @deffn Command {dap init}
4331 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4332 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4333 initialization, too.
4334 @end deffn
4335
4336 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4337
4338 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4339 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4340 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4341 @end deffn
4342
4343 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4344 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4345 @end deffn
4346
4347 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4348 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4349 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4350 or set a new value @var{value}.
4351 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4352 @end deffn
4353
4354 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4355 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4356 @end deffn
4357
4358 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4359 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4360 value @var{value}.
4361
4362 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4363 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4364 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4365
4366 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4367 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4368 @end deffn
4369
4370 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4371 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4372 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4373 @end deffn
4374
4375 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4376 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4377 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4378 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4379 @end deffn
4380
4381 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4382 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4383
4384 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4385 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4386 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4387 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4388 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4389 for details.
4390
4391 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4392 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4393 the pattern:
4394 @example
4395 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4396 @end example
4397
4398 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4399 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4400 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4401 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4402 @example
4403 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4404 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4405 @end example
4406
4407 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4408 @example
4409 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4410 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4411 @end example
4412
4413 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4414 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4415
4416 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4417 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4418 example with a proper dap name:
4419 @example
4420 xxx.dap apcsw default
4421 @end example
4422 @end deffn
4423
4424 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4425 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4426 Disabled by default
4427 @end deffn
4428
4429
4430 @node CPU Configuration
4431 @chapter CPU Configuration
4432 @cindex GDB target
4433
4434 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4435 You can also access these targets without GDB
4436 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4437 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4438 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4439 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4440
4441 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4442 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4443
4444 @section Target List
4445 @cindex target, current
4446 @cindex target, list
4447
4448 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4449 where each member has a name.
4450 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4451 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4452 (plural!) command.
4453 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4454 look like with more than one:
4455 @verbatim
4456 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4457 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4458 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4459 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4460 @end verbatim
4461
4462 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4463 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4464 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4465 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4466 space seen by that current target.
4467 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4468 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4469 are examples; and there are many more.
4470
4471 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4472
4473 @deffn Command {target current}
4474 Returns the name of the current target.
4475 @end deffn
4476
4477 @deffn Command {target names}
4478 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4479 @example
4480 foreach t [target names] @{
4481 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4482 @}
4483 @end example
4484 @end deffn
4485
4486 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4487 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4488
4489 @deffn Command targets [name]
4490 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4491 command names are singular.}
4492
4493 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4494 targets in a user friendly form.
4495
4496 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4497 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4498 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4499 @end deffn
4500
4501 @section Target CPU Types
4502 @cindex target type
4503 @cindex CPU type
4504
4505 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4506 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4507 when calling @command{target create}.
4508 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4509 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4510 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4511 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4512 what core-specific commands may be available
4513 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4514 and more.
4515
4516 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4517 since there's a command to list them.
4518
4519 @anchor{targettypes}
4520 @deffn Command {target types}
4521 Lists all supported target types.
4522 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4523
4524 @itemize @bullet
4525 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU.
4526 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores.
4527 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4528 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4529 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU.
4530 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4531 @item @code{arm946e} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU.
4532 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core.
4533 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core.
4534 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4535 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4536 @item @code{avr32_ap7k} -- this an AVR32 core.
4537 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7-A core with an MMU.
4538 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7-M core, supporting only the
4539 compact Thumb2 instruction set. Supports also ARMv6-M and ARMv8-M cores
4540 @item @code{cortex_r4} -- this is an ARMv7-R core.
4541 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e.
4542 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4543 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4544 @item @code{dsp5680xx} -- implements Freescale's 5680x DSP.
4545 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4546 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4547 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb).
4548 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926.
4549 @item @code{hla_target} -- a Cortex-M alternative to work with HL adapters like ST-Link.
4550 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4551 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4552 @item @code{mem_ap} -- this is an ARM debug infrastructure Access Port without a CPU, through which bus read and write cycles can be generated; it may be useful for working with non-CPU hardware behind an AP or during development of support for new CPUs.
4553 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core.
4554 @item @code{mips_mips64} -- a MIPS64 core.
4555 @item @code{nds32_v2} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v2 core.
4556 @item @code{nds32_v3} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3 core.
4557 @item @code{nds32_v3m} -- this is an Andes NDS32 v3m core.
4558 @item @code{or1k} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4559 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4560 @itemize @minus
4561 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}jtag})
4562 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4563 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4564 @end itemize
4565 And two debug interfaces cores:
4566 @itemize @minus
4567 @item @code{Advanced debug interface}
4568 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}adv_debug_sys})
4569 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface}
4570 @*(See: @url{http://opencores.org/project@comma{}dbg_interface})
4571 @end itemize
4572 @item @code{quark_d20xx} -- an Intel Quark D20xx core.
4573 @item @code{quark_x10xx} -- an Intel Quark X10xx core.
4574 @item @code{riscv} -- a RISC-V core.
4575 @item @code{stm8} -- implements an STM8 core.
4576 @item @code{testee} -- a dummy target for cases without a real CPU, e.g. CPLD.
4577 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4578 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4579 @end itemize
4580 @end deffn
4581
4582 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4583 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4584 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4585 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4586 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4587 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4588 reflect design generations;
4589 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4590 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4591
4592 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4593 @section Target Configuration
4594
4595 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4596 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4597 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4598 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4599 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4600
4601 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4602 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4603 optional parts.
4604 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4605 command, created as part of target creation.
4606
4607 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4608 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4609 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4610 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4611 to be much more board-specific.
4612 The key steps you use might look something like this
4613
4614 @example
4615 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4616 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4617 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4618 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4619 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4620 @end example
4621
4622 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4623 on-chip SRAM.
4624 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4625 writes to target memory;
4626 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4627 GDB memory checksumming;
4628 and more.
4629
4630 @quotation Warning
4631 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4632 inaccessible when application code
4633 (such as an operating system)
4634 enables or disables the MMU.
4635 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4636 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4637 easy access to other addresses needed.
4638 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4639 @end quotation
4640
4641 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4642 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4643 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4644 controllers.
4645 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4646 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4647 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4648
4649 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4650 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4651 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4652 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4653 purposes including additional configuration.
4654
4655 @itemize @bullet
4656 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4657 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4658 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4659 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4660
4661 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4662 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4663 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4664 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4665 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4666 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4667 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4668
4669 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4670 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4671 @end itemize
4672 @end deffn
4673
4674 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4675 The options accepted by this command may also be
4676 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4677 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4678 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4679
4680 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4681 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4682 and changing its endianness.
4683
4684 @itemize @bullet
4685
4686 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4687 used to access this target.
4688
4689 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4690 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4691 create and manage DAP instances.
4692
4693 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4694 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4695
4696 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4697 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4698 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4699 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4700 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4701 same event name assigns only one handler.
4702
4703 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4704 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4705
4706 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4707 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4708 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4709 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4710 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4711 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4712 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4713
4714 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4715 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4716 or virtual address is being used.
4717
4718 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4719 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4720
4721 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4722 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4723 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4724 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4725 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4726
4727 @anchor{rtostype}
4728 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4729 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4730 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4731 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx},
4732 @option{RIOT}
4733 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4734
4735 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4736 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4737 access the target for debugging.
4738
4739 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4740 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4741 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4742 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4743
4744 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4745 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4746 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4747 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4748 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4749
4750 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4751 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4752 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4753 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4754 command @command{gdb_port}.
4755 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4756
4757 @item @code{-gdb-max-connections} @var{number} -- EXPERIMENTAL: set the maximum
4758 number of GDB connections that are allowed for the target. Default is 1.
4759 A negative value for @var{number} means unlimited connections.
4760 See @xref{gdbmeminspect,,Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}.
4761 @end itemize
4762 @end deffn
4763
4764 @section Other $target_name Commands
4765 @cindex object command
4766
4767 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4768 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4769
4770 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4771 Once a button is created a button
4772 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4773 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4774 configure it like this:
4775
4776 @example
4777 # Create
4778 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4779 # Modify
4780 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4781 # Query
4782 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4783 # Report
4784 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4785 @end example
4786
4787 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4788 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4789
4790 @example
4791 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4792 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4793 @end example
4794
4795 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4796
4797 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4798 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4799 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4800 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4801 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4802 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4803 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4804 They are not otherwise documented here.
4805 @end deffn
4806
4807 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4808 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4809 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4810 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4811 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4812 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4813 the target side uses raw memory.
4814
4815 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4816 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4817 The script orientation comes from working with data
4818 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4819 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4820 and neither store nor return those values.
4821
4822 @itemize
4823 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4824 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4825 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4826 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4827 @end itemize
4828 @end deffn
4829
4830 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4831 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4832 @command{$target_name configure}
4833 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4834 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4835 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4836 There are a few special cases:
4837
4838 @itemize @bullet
4839 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4840 event named @var{event_name}.
4841 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4842 two parameters.
4843 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4844 This is a special case because this is set using
4845 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4846 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4847 @end itemize
4848
4849 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4850 all the targets you might use something like this:
4851
4852 @example
4853 foreach name [target names] @{
4854 set y [$name cget -endian]
4855 set z [$name cget -type]
4856 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4857 $x $name $y $z]
4858 @}
4859 @end example
4860 @end deffn
4861
4862 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4863 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4864 Displays the current target state:
4865 @code{debug-running},
4866 @code{halted},
4867 @code{reset},
4868 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4869 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4870 @end deffn
4871
4872 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4873 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4874 currently associated with this target.
4875 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4876 @end deffn
4877
4878 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4879 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4880 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4881 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4882 @end deffn
4883
4884 @deffn Command {$target_name mdd} [phys] addr [count]
4885 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdw} [phys] addr [count]
4886 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} [phys] addr [count]
4887 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} [phys] addr [count]
4888 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4889 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
4890 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4891 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4892 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4893 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4894 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4895 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4896 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4897 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4898 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4899 @end deffn
4900
4901 @deffn Command {$target_name mwd} [phys] addr doubleword [count]
4902 @deffnx Command {$target_name mww} [phys] addr word [count]
4903 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} [phys] addr halfword [count]
4904 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} [phys] addr byte [count]
4905 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
4906 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
4907 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4908 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
4909 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
4910 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
4911 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
4912 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
4913 @end deffn
4914
4915 @anchor{targetevents}
4916 @section Target Events
4917 @cindex target events
4918 @cindex events
4919 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4920 For example:
4921 @itemize @bullet
4922 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4923 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4924 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4925 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4926 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4927 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4928 to set up system clocks or
4929 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4930 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4931 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4932 @end itemize
4933
4934 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4935 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4936 @command{target create ... -event}.
4937
4938 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4939 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4940 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4941
4942 @example
4943 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4944 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4945 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4946 @}
4947 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4948 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4949 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4950 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4951 @}
4952 @end example
4953
4954 The following target events are defined:
4955
4956 @itemize @bullet
4957 @item @b{debug-halted}
4958 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4959 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4960 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4961 @item @b{early-halted}
4962 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4963 @item @b{examine-start}
4964 @* Before target examine is called.
4965 @item @b{examine-end}
4966 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4967 @item @b{examine-fail}
4968 @* After target examine fails.
4969 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4970 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4971 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4972 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4973 connect GDB to running target.
4974 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4975 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4976 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4977 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4978 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4979 is in RAM or read only memory.
4980 Default is @code{halt}
4981 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4982 @* When GDB disconnects
4983 @item @b{gdb-end}
4984 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4985 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4986 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4987 @code{reset init})
4988 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4989 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4990 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4991 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4992 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4993 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4994 @item @b{gdb-start}
4995 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4996 @item @b{halted}
4997 @* The target has halted
4998 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4999 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5000 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
5001 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
5002 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
5003 @item @b{reset-assert}
5004 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5005 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
5006 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
5007 it instead of asserting SRST.
5008 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
5009 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
5010 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
5011 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
5012 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5013 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
5014 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
5015 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
5016 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5017 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
5018 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
5019 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
5020 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
5021 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
5022 released on the scan chain.
5023 @item @b{reset-end}
5024 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
5025 @item @b{reset-init}
5026 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
5027 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
5028
5029 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
5030 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
5031 multiplexing, and so on.
5032 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
5033 the target clocks are fully set up.)
5034 @item @b{reset-start}
5035 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
5036 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
5037
5038 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
5039 or @command{adapter speed} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
5040 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
5041 @item @b{resume-start}
5042 @* Before any target is resumed
5043 @item @b{resume-end}
5044 @* After all targets have resumed
5045 @item @b{resumed}
5046 @* Target has resumed
5047 @item @b{step-start}
5048 @* Before a target is single-stepped
5049 @item @b{step-end}
5050 @* After single-step has completed
5051 @item @b{trace-config}
5052 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
5053 @end itemize
5054
5055 @quotation Note
5056 OpenOCD events are not supposed to be preempt by another event, but this
5057 is not enforced in current code. Only the target event @b{resumed} is
5058 executed with polling disabled; this avoids polling to trigger the event
5059 @b{halted}, reversing the logical order of execution of their handlers.
5060 Future versions of OpenOCD will prevent the event preemption and will
5061 disable the schedule of polling during the event execution. Do not rely
5062 on polling in any event handler; this means, don't expect the status of
5063 a core to change during the execution of the handler. The event handler
5064 will have to enable polling or use @command{$target_name arp_poll} to
5065 check if the core has changed status.
5066 @end quotation
5067
5068 @node Flash Commands
5069 @chapter Flash Commands
5070
5071 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
5072 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
5073 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
5074 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
5075 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
5076 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
5077 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
5078 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
5079 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
5080
5081 Flash Steps:
5082 @enumerate
5083 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
5084 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
5085 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
5086 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
5087 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
5088 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
5089 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
5090 @item GDB Flashing
5091 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
5092 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
5093 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
5094 @end enumerate
5095
5096 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
5097 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
5098 so that it can't boot.
5099 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
5100 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
5101
5102 @anchor{norconfiguration}
5103 @section Flash Configuration Commands
5104 @cindex flash configuration
5105
5106 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
5107 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
5108 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
5109 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
5110 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
5111 see the driver-specific documentation.
5112
5113 @itemize @bullet
5114 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
5115 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
5116 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
5117 associated with the flash bank being declared.
5118 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
5119 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
5120 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
5121 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
5122 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
5123 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
5124 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
5125 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5126 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
5127 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
5128 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
5129 commands to the flash controller.
5130 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
5131 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
5132 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
5133 for more information.
5134 @end itemize
5135 @quotation Note
5136 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
5137 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
5138 @end quotation
5139 @end deffn
5140
5141 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
5142 @deffn Command {flash banks}
5143 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
5144 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5145 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
5146 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
5147 @end deffn
5148
5149 @deffn Command {flash list}
5150 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
5151 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
5152 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
5153 @end deffn
5154
5155 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
5156 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
5157 depends on the flash type.
5158 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5159 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
5160 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
5161 but most don't bother.
5162 @end deffn
5163
5164 @section Preparing a Target before Flash Programming
5165
5166 The target device should be in well defined state before the flash programming
5167 begins.
5168
5169 @emph{Always issue} @command{reset init} before @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
5170 Do not issue another @command{reset} or @command{reset halt} or @command{resume}
5171 until the programming session is finished.
5172
5173 If you use @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
5174 the target is prepared automatically in the event gdb-flash-erase-start
5175
5176 The jimtcl script @command{program} calls @command{reset init} explicitly.
5177
5178 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
5179 @cindex flash erasing
5180 @cindex flash reading
5181 @cindex flash writing
5182 @cindex flash programming
5183 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
5184
5185 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
5186 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
5187 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
5188 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
5189 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
5190
5191 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
5192 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
5193 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
5194 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
5195 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
5196
5197 @quotation Note
5198 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
5199 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
5200 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
5201 back to a flash bank.
5202 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
5203 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
5204 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
5205 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
5206 Avoid confusing the two command models.
5207 @end quotation
5208
5209 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
5210 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
5211 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
5212 disabled first.
5213 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
5214 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
5215 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
5216
5217 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
5218 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
5219 up to and including @var{last}.
5220 Sector numbering starts at 0.
5221 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
5222 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5223 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5224 @end deffn
5225
5226 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
5227 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
5228 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
5229 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
5230 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
5231 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
5232 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
5233 the specified length must stay within that bank.
5234 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
5235 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
5236 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
5237 before erase starts.
5238 @end deffn
5239
5240 @deffn Command {flash filld} address double-word length
5241 @deffnx Command {flash fillw} address word length
5242 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
5243 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
5244 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{double-word} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
5245 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
5246 starting at @var{address} and continuing
5247 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
5248 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
5249 before issuing this command.
5250 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
5251 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
5252 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5253 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5254 @end deffn
5255 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
5256
5257 @deffn Command {flash mdw} addr [count]
5258 @deffnx Command {flash mdh} addr [count]
5259 @deffnx Command {flash mdb} addr [count]
5260 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
5261 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
5262 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
5263 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
5264 Reads from flash using the flash driver, therefore it enables reading
5265 from a bank not mapped in target address space.
5266 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
5267 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
5268 @end deffn
5269
5270 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
5271 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
5272 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
5273 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
5274 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5275 @end deffn
5276
5277 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
5278 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
5279 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
5280 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
5281 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
5282 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5283 @end deffn
5284
5285 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
5286 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
5287 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
5288 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
5289 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5290 @end deffn
5291
5292 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
5293 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5294 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
5295 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
5296 to the base address for each section in the image.
5297 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
5298 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
5299 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
5300 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
5301 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
5302 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
5303 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
5304 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
5305 each image section.
5306
5307 @quotation Warning
5308 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
5309 data you want to preserve.
5310 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
5311 sections might be erased with no notice.
5312 @itemize
5313 @item
5314 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
5315 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
5316 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
5317 @item
5318 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
5319 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
5320 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
5321 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
5322 @end itemize
5323 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
5324 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
5325 @end quotation
5326
5327 @end deffn
5328
5329 @deffn Command {flash verify_image} filename [offset] [type]
5330 Verify the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
5331 Parameters follow the description of 'flash write_image'.
5332 In contrast to the 'verify_image' command, for banks with specific
5333 verify method, that one is used instead of the usual target's read
5334 memory methods. This is necessary for flash banks not readable by
5335 ordinary memory reads.
5336 This command gives only an overall good/bad result for each bank, not
5337 addresses of individual failed bytes as it's intended only as quick
5338 check for successful programming.
5339 @end deffn
5340
5341 @section Other Flash commands
5342 @cindex flash protection
5343
5344 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
5345 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
5346 and display that status.
5347 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5348 @end deffn
5349
5350 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
5351 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
5352 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
5353
5354 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5355 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5356 and possibly stale information.
5357 @end deffn
5358
5359 @anchor{flashprotect}
5360 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5361 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5362 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5363 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5364 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5365 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5366 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5367 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5368 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5369 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5370 @end deffn
5371
5372 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5373 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5374 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5375 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5376 @end deffn
5377
5378 @anchor{program}
5379 @deffn Command {program} filename [preverify] [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5380 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5381 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5382 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5383 @end deffn
5384
5385 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5386 @section Flash Driver List
5387 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5388 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5389 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5390
5391 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5392 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5393 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5394
5395 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5396
5397 @itemize
5398 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5399 @end itemize
5400
5401 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5402 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5403 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5404 @example
5405 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5406 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5407 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5408 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5409 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5410 @end example
5411 @end deffn
5412
5413 @subsection External Flash
5414
5415 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5416 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5417 @cindex CFI
5418 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5419 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5420 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5421 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5422 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5423 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5424 configure a bus and its timings), or
5425 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5426 on the flash chip.
5427 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5428 speed up operation.
5429
5430 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5431
5432 @itemize
5433 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5434 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5435 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5436 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5437 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5438 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5439 @end itemize
5440
5441 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5442 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5443
5444 @example
5445 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5446 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5447 @end example
5448
5449 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5450 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5451 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5452
5453 @example
5454 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5455 @end example
5456
5457 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5458 @end deffn
5459
5460 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5461 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5462 @cindex SPI
5463 @cindex jtagspi
5464 @cindex bscan_spi
5465 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5466 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5467 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5468 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5469 accessed through JTAG.
5470
5471 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5472 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5473 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5474 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5475 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5476 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5477
5478 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5479 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5480 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5481 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5482 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5483 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5484 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5485 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5486
5487 @itemize
5488 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5489 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5490 @var{USER1} instruction.
5491 @end itemize
5492
5493 @example
5494 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5495 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5496 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5497 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5498 @end example
5499 @end deffn
5500
5501 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5502 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5503 @cindex xcf
5504 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5505 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5506 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5507 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5508 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5509
5510 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5511 command accepts additional parameters:
5512 @itemize
5513 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5514 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5515 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5516 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5517 in master mode.
5518 @end itemize
5519 @example
5520 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5521 @end example
5522 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5523 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5524 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5525 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5526 dedicated sector.
5527 @end deffn
5528
5529 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5530 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5531 button.
5532 @example
5533 xcf configure 0
5534 @end example
5535 @end deffn
5536
5537 Additional driver notes:
5538 @itemize
5539 @item Only single revision supported.
5540 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5541 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5542 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5543 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5544 @end itemize
5545 @end deffn
5546
5547 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5548 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5549 @cindex SPIFI
5550 @cindex lpcspifi
5551 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5552 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5553 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5554
5555 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5556 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5557 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5558 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5559 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5560
5561 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5562 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5563 are configured by the driver.
5564
5565 @example
5566 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5567 @end example
5568
5569 @end deffn
5570
5571 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5572 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5573 @cindex SMI
5574 @cindex stmsmi
5575 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5576 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5577 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5578 SPI flash devices.
5579 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5580 flash devices can be connected.
5581
5582 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5583 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5584 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5585 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5586 the flash content.
5587
5588 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5589 to identify the memory bank.
5590 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5591 flash size, are detected automatically.
5592
5593 @example
5594 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5595 @end example
5596
5597 @end deffn
5598
5599 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmqspi
5600 @cindex STMicroelectronics QuadSPI/OctoSPI Interface
5601 @cindex QuadSPI
5602 @cindex OctoSPI
5603 @cindex stmqspi
5604 Some devices from STMicroelectronics include a proprietary ``QuadSPI Interface''
5605 (e.g. STM32F4, STM32F7, STM32L4) or ``OctoSPI Interface'' (e.g. STM32L4+)
5606 controller able to drive one or even two (dual mode) external SPI flash devices.
5607 The OctoSPI is a superset of QuadSPI, its presence is detected automatically.
5608 Currently only the regular command mode is supported, whereas the HyperFlash
5609 mode is not.
5610
5611 QuadSPI/OctoSPI makes the flash contents directly accessible in the CPU address
5612 space; in case of dual mode both devices must be of the same type and are
5613 mapped in the same memory bank (even and odd addresses interleaved).
5614 CPU can directly read data, execute code (but not boot) from QuadSPI bank.
5615
5616 The 'flash bank' command only requires the @var{base} parameter and the extra
5617 parameter @var{io_base} in order to identify the memory bank. Both are fixed
5618 by hardware, see datasheet or RM. All other parameters are ignored.
5619
5620 The controller must be initialized after each reset and properly configured
5621 for memory-mapped read operation for the particular flash chip(s), for the full
5622 list of available register settings cf. the controller's RM. This setup is quite
5623 board specific (that's why booting from this memory is not possible). The
5624 flash driver infers all parameters from current controller register values when
5625 'flash probe @var{bank_id}' is executed.
5626
5627 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display the flash content,
5628 but only after proper controller initialization as decribed above. However,
5629 due to a silicon bug in some devices, attempting to access the very last word
5630 should be avoided.
5631
5632 It is possible to use two (even different) flash chips alternatingly, if individual
5633 bank chip selects are available. For some package variants, this is not the case
5634 due to limited pin count. To switch from one to another, adjust FSEL bit accordingly
5635 and re-issue 'flash probe bank_id'. Note that the bank base address will @emph{not}
5636 change, so the address spaces of both devices will overlap. In dual flash mode
5637 both chips must be identical regarding size and most other properties.
5638
5639 Block or sector protection internal to the flash chip is not handled by this
5640 driver at all, but can be dealt with manually by the 'cmd' command, see below.
5641 The sector protection via 'flash protect' command etc. is completely internal to
5642 openocd, intended only to prevent accidental erase or overwrite and it does not
5643 persist across openocd invocations.
5644
5645 OpenOCD contains a hardcoded list of flash devices with their properties,
5646 these are auto-detected. If a device is not included in this list, SFDP discovery
5647 is attempted. If this fails or gives inappropriate results, manual setting is
5648 required (see 'set' command).
5649
5650 @example
5651 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x90000000 0 0 0 \
5652 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001000
5653 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmqspi 0x70000000 0 0 0 \
5654 $_TARGETNAME 0xA0001400
5655 @end example
5656
5657 There are three specific commands
5658 @deffn Command {stmqspi mass_erase} bank_id
5659 Clears sector protections and performs a mass erase. Works only if there is no
5660 chip specific write protection engaged.
5661 @end deffn
5662
5663 @deffn Command {stmqspi set} bank_id name total_size page_size read_cmd fread_cmd pprg_cmd mass_erase_cmd sector_size sector_erase_cmd
5664 Set flash parameters: @var{name} human readable string, @var{total_size} size
5665 in bytes, @var{page_size} is write page size. @var{read_cmd}, @var{fread_cmd} and @var{pprg_cmd}
5666 are commands for reading and page programming. @var{fread_cmd} is used in DPI and QPI modes,
5667 @var{read_cmd} in normal SPI (single line) mode. @var{mass_erase_cmd}, @var{sector_size}
5668 and @var{sector_erase_cmd} are optional.
5669
5670 This command is required if chip id is not hardcoded yet and e.g. for EEPROMs or FRAMs
5671 which don't support an id command.
5672
5673 In dual mode parameters of both chips are set identically. The parameters refer to
5674 a single chip, so the whole bank gets twice the specified capacity etc.
5675 @end deffn
5676
5677 @deffn Command {stmqspi cmd} bank_id resp_num cmd_byte ...
5678 If @var{resp_num} is zero, sends command @var{cmd_byte} and following data
5679 bytes. In dual mode command byte is sent to @emph{both} chips but data bytes are
5680 sent @emph{alternatingly} to chip 1 and 2, first to flash 1, second to flash 2, etc.,
5681 i.e. the total number of bytes (including cmd_byte) must be odd.
5682
5683 If @var{resp_num} is not zero, cmd and at most four following data bytes are
5684 sent, in dual mode @emph{simultaneously} to both chips. Then @var{resp_num} bytes
5685 are read interleaved from both chips starting with chip 1. In this case
5686 @var{resp_num} must be even.
5687
5688 Note the hardware dictated subtle difference of those two cases in dual-flash mode.
5689
5690 To check basic communication settings, issue
5691 @example
5692 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5693 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05
5694 @end example
5695 for single flash mode or
5696 @example
5697 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x04; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5698 stmqspi cmd bank_id 0 0x06; stmqspi cmd bank_id 2 0x05
5699 @end example
5700 for dual flash mode. This should return the status register contents.
5701
5702 In 8-line mode, @var{cmd_byte} is sent twice - first time as given, second time
5703 complemented. Additionally, in 8-line mode only, some commands (e.g. Read Status)
5704 need a dummy address, e.g.
5705 @example
5706 stmqspi cmd bank_id 1 0x05 0x00 0x00 0x00 0x00
5707 @end example
5708 should return the status register contents.
5709
5710 @end deffn
5711
5712 @end deffn
5713
5714 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5715 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5716 Microcontroller platform.
5717
5718 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5719 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5720
5721 @example
5722 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5723 @end example
5724
5725 @end deffn
5726
5727 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5728 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5729 @cindex ath79
5730 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5731 chip selects.
5732 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5733 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5734 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5735 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5736 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5737 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5738
5739 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5740 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5741 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5742 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5743 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5744 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5745 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5746 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5747 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5748 with the default CS0.
5749 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5750 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5751 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5752
5753 @example
5754 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5755
5756 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different
5757 # for each, otherwise the write_image command is not able to
5758 # distinguish the banks.
5759 flash bank flash0 ath79 0xbf000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5760 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5761 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5762 @end example
5763
5764 @end deffn
5765
5766 @deffn {Flash Driver} fespi
5767 @cindex Freedom E SPI
5768 @cindex fespi
5769
5770 SiFive's Freedom E SPI controller, used in HiFive and other boards.
5771
5772 @example
5773 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fespi 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5774 @end example
5775 @end deffn
5776
5777 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5778
5779 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5780 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5781 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5782 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5783 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5784 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5785
5786 @example
5787 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5788 @end example
5789 @end deffn
5790
5791 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5792 @cindex ambiqmicro
5793 @cindex apollo
5794 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5795 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5796 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5797 with the target using SWD.
5798
5799 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5800 the device class of the MCU.
5801 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5802 to set up the flash banks.
5803 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5804 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5805
5806 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5807 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5808 and the second bank starts after the first.
5809
5810 @example
5811 # Flash bank 0
5812 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5813 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5814 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5815 $_TARGETNAME
5816 @end example
5817
5818 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5819 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5820 are available to the user.
5821
5822 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5823
5824 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5825 Erase entire bank.
5826 @end deffn
5827 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5828 Erase device pages.
5829 @end deffn
5830 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5831 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5832 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5833 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5834 the flash.
5835 @end deffn
5836 @end deffn
5837
5838 @anchor{at91samd}
5839 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5840 @cindex at91samd
5841 All members of the ATSAM D2x, D1x, D0x, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5842 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5843
5844 Do not use for ATSAM D51 and E5x: use @xref{atsame5}.
5845
5846 The devices have one flash bank:
5847
5848 @example
5849 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91samd 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5850 @end example
5851
5852 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5853 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5854 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5855 processor to be halted.
5856 @end deffn
5857
5858 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5859 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5860 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5861 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5862 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5863 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5864
5865 @example
5866 at91samd set-security enable
5867 @end example
5868 @end deffn
5869
5870 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5871 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5872 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5873 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5874 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5875 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5876 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5877 in order to disable this feature.
5878
5879 @example
5880 at91samd eeprom
5881 at91samd eeprom 1024
5882 @end example
5883 @end deffn
5884
5885 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5886 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5887 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5888 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5889 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5890 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5891
5892 @example
5893 at91samd bootloader
5894 at91samd bootloader 16384
5895 @end example
5896 @end deffn
5897
5898 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5899 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5900 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5901 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
5902 @end deffn
5903
5904 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5905 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5906 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5907 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5908 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5909 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5910 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5911 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5912
5913 @example
5914 # Read user row
5915 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5916 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5917 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5918 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5919 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low
5920 # byte unchanged
5921 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5922 @end example
5923 @end deffn
5924
5925 @end deffn
5926
5927 @anchor{at91sam3}
5928 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5929 @cindex at91sam3
5930 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5931 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5932 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5933 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5934 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5935 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5936 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5937 chips are confirmed.}
5938
5939 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5940 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5941 the following fixed locations:
5942
5943 @example
5944 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5945 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5946 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5947 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5948 @end example
5949
5950 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5951 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5952 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5953
5954 @itemize
5955 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5956 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5957 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5958 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5959 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5960 @end itemize
5961
5962 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5963
5964 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5965 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5966 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5967 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5968 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5969 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5970 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5971
5972 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5973 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5974 @end deffn
5975
5976 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5977 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5978 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5979 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5980 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5981 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5982 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5983 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5984 @end deffn
5985
5986 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5987 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5988 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5989 @end deffn
5990 @end deffn
5991
5992 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5993 @cindex at91sam4
5994 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5995 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5996 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5997 @end deffn
5998
5999 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
6000 @cindex at91sam4l
6001 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
6002 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6003 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6004
6005 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
6006 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
6007 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
6008 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6009 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6010 @end deffn
6011 @end deffn
6012
6013 @anchor{atsame5}
6014 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsame5
6015 @cindex atsame5
6016 All members of the SAM E54, E53, E51 and D51 microcontroller
6017 families from Microchip (former Atmel) include internal flash
6018 and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
6019
6020 The devices have two ECC flash banks with a swapping feature.
6021 This driver handles both banks together as it were one.
6022 Bank swapping is not supported yet.
6023
6024 @example
6025 flash bank $_FLASHNAME atsame5 0x00000000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
6026 @end example
6027
6028 @deffn Command {atsame5 bootloader}
6029 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Page of the
6030 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
6031 must be specified in bytes. The nearest bigger protection size is used.
6032 Settings are written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset.
6033 Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
6034
6035 @example
6036 atsame5 bootloader
6037 atsame5 bootloader 16384
6038 @end example
6039 @end deffn
6040
6041 @deffn Command {atsame5 chip-erase}
6042 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
6043 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
6044 processor to be halted.
6045 @end deffn
6046
6047 @deffn Command {atsame5 dsu_reset_deassert}
6048 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
6049 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
6050 Command is used internally in event reset-deassert-post.
6051 @end deffn
6052
6053 @deffn Command {atsame5 userpage}
6054 Writes or reads the first 64 bits of NVM User Page which is located at
6055 0x804000. This field includes various fuses.
6056 Reading is done by invoking this command without any arguments.
6057 Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
6058 is the value to be written and the second one is an optional bit mask
6059 (a zero bit in the mask means the bit stays unchanged).
6060 The reserved fields are always masked out and cannot be changed.
6061
6062 @example
6063 # Read
6064 >atsame5 userpage
6065 USER PAGE: 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6066 # Write
6067 >atsame5 userpage 0xAEECFF80FE9A9239
6068 # Write 2 to SEESBLK and 4 to SEEPSZ fields but leave other
6069 # bits unchanged (setup SmartEEPROM of virtual size 8192
6070 # bytes)
6071 >atsame5 userpage 0x4200000000 0x7f00000000
6072 @end example
6073 @end deffn
6074
6075 @end deffn
6076
6077 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
6078 @cindex atsamv
6079 All members of the ATSAMV7x, ATSAMS70, and ATSAME70 families from
6080 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
6081 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
6082 @end deffn
6083
6084 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
6085 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
6086 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
6087 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
6088 register, and autoconfigures itself.
6089
6090 @example
6091 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6092 @end example
6093
6094 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
6095 provide additional parameters in the following order:
6096
6097 @itemize
6098 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
6099 @item @var{banks}
6100 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
6101 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
6102 @item @var{pages_size}
6103 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
6104 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
6105 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
6106 @end itemize
6107
6108 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
6109 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
6110 will be autoconfigured.
6111 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
6112
6113 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
6114 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
6115 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
6116 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
6117 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
6118
6119 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
6120 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
6121 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
6122 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
6123 are not truly general purpose).
6124 @quotation Note
6125 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
6126 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
6127 @end quotation
6128 @end deffn
6129 @end deffn
6130
6131 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
6132 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
6133 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
6134 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6135 @end deffn
6136
6137 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
6138 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1, BlueNRG-2 and BlueNRG-LP Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0/M0+ core and internal flash memory.
6139 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
6140 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
6141
6142 @example
6143 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6144 @end example
6145
6146 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
6147 each single sector one by one.
6148
6149 @example
6150 flash erase_sector 0 0 last # It will perform a mass erase
6151 @end example
6152
6153 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
6154 @end deffn
6155
6156 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
6157 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
6158 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
6159 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
6160 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. The flash bank
6161 starts at address 0.
6162
6163 @example
6164 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6165 @end example
6166 @end deffn
6167
6168 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
6169 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
6170 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
6171 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
6172 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
6173 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
6174 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
6175 and programming the serial flash.
6176
6177 @example
6178 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6179 @end example
6180 @end deffn
6181
6182 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
6183 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
6184 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
6185 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
6186 autoconfigures itself.
6187 @example
6188 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6189 @end example
6190 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
6191 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
6192 this via the following command:
6193 @example
6194 efm32 debuglock num
6195 @end example
6196 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6197 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
6198 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
6199 supported.}
6200 @end deffn
6201
6202 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
6203 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
6204 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
6205 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
6206 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
6207 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
6208
6209 @example
6210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 \
6211 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
6212 @end example
6213
6214 @deffn Command {esirisc flash mass_erase} bank_id
6215 Erase all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
6216 @end deffn
6217
6218 @deffn Command {esirisc flash ref_erase} bank_id
6219 Erase the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. @emph{This
6220 is an uncommon operation.}
6221 @end deffn
6222 @end deffn
6223
6224 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
6225 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
6226 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6227 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
6228 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6229 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
6230 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
6231
6232 @example
6233 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6234 @end example
6235 @end deffn
6236
6237 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
6238 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
6239 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6240 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
6241 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
6242 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
6243 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
6244 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
6245 characters) ignored.
6246
6247 @example
6248 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
6249 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6250 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
6251 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
6252 @end example
6253 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
6254 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
6255 @end deffn
6256
6257 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
6258 @cindex kinetis
6259 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
6260 from NXP (former Freescale) include
6261 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
6262 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
6263 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6264 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
6265
6266 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
6267 @itemize
6268 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
6269 @end itemize
6270
6271 @example
6272 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6273 @end example
6274
6275 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
6276 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
6277 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
6278 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
6279 @end deffn
6280
6281 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
6282 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
6283 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
6284 set by 'flash protect' command.
6285 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
6286 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
6287 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
6288 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
6289 with the rest of a flash image.
6290 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
6291 @end deffn
6292
6293 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
6294 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
6295 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
6296 @end deffn
6297
6298 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
6299 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end
6300 and examine-fail event.
6301 @end deffn
6302
6303 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
6304 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
6305 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
6306 @end deffn
6307
6308 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
6309 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
6310 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
6311 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
6312 command completes.
6313 @end deffn
6314
6315 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
6316 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
6317 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
6318 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
6319 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
6320
6321 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
6322 Program Partition command.
6323
6324 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
6325 Reset the device after partition setting.
6326
6327 Show partition size:
6328 @example
6329 kinetis nvm_partition info
6330 @end example
6331
6332 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
6333 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6334 @example
6335 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
6336 @end example
6337
6338 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
6339 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
6340 @example
6341 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
6342 @end example
6343 @end deffn
6344
6345 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
6346 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
6347 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
6348 @end deffn
6349
6350 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
6351 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
6352 Command disables watchdog timer.
6353 @end deffn
6354 @end deffn
6355
6356 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
6357 @cindex kinetis_ke
6358 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
6359 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
6360 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
6361 autoconfigures itself.
6362 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
6363
6364 @example
6365 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6366 @end example
6367
6368 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
6369 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
6370 @end deffn
6371
6372 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
6373 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
6374 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
6375 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
6376 It does not require the processor to be halted.
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
6380 Command disables watchdog timer.
6381 @end deffn
6382 @end deffn
6383
6384 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
6385 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
6386 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
6387 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000, LPC54100,
6388 LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx microcontroller families from NXP.
6389
6390 @quotation Note
6391 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
6392 driver:
6393 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
6394 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
6395 @end quotation
6396
6397 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and two optional parameters,
6398 which must appear in the following order:
6399
6400 @itemize
6401 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
6402 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
6403 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
6404 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
6405 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
6406 LPC43x[2357])
6407 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
6408 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
6409 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
6410 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
6411 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
6412 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
6413 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx, LPC40xx, LPC8Nxx and NHS31xx
6414 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
6415 at which the core is running
6416 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
6417 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
6418 @quotation Note
6419 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
6420 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
6421 However, if you do provide it,
6422 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
6423 @end quotation
6424 @item @option{iap_entry} ... optional telling the driver to use a different
6425 ROM IAP entry point.
6426 @end itemize
6427
6428 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6429
6430 @example
6431 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
6432 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
6433 @end example
6434
6435 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
6436 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
6437 the specified flash @var{bank}.
6438 @end deffn
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
6442 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
6443 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
6444 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
6445 the programming clock rate in Hz.
6446 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6447
6448 @example
6449 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
6450 @end example
6451 @end deffn
6452
6453 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
6454 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
6455 from NXP.
6456
6457 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
6458 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
6459 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6460 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
6461 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
6462 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
6463 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
6464 you start the PLL.
6465
6466 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
6467
6468 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
6469 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
6470 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
6471
6472 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
6473 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
6474 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
6475 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
6476 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
6477 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
6478 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
6479
6480 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
6481 @example
6482 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
6483 @end example
6484
6485 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
6486 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
6487 @code{flash banks} command.
6488
6489 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
6490 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
6491 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
6492 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
6493 a known signature.
6494 Example:
6495 @example
6496 lpc2900 signature 0
6497 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
6498 @end example
6499 @end deffn
6500
6501 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
6502 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
6503 saves it to a file in binary format.
6504 Example:
6505 @example
6506 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
6507 @end example
6508 @end deffn
6509
6510 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
6511 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
6512 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
6513 command:
6514
6515 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
6516 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
6517 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
6518 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
6519
6520 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
6521 Example:
6522 @example
6523 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
6524 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
6525 @end example
6526 @end deffn
6527
6528 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
6529 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
6530 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
6531 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
6532 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
6533 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
6534 912 bytes.
6535 @quotation Attention
6536 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6537 @end quotation
6538 Example:
6539 @example
6540 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
6541 @end example
6542 @end deffn
6543
6544 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
6545 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
6546 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
6547 after the next power cycle.
6548 @quotation Attention
6549 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6550 @end quotation
6551 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
6552 Example:
6553 @example
6554 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6555 flash info 0
6556 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6557 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6558 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6559 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6560 @end example
6561 @end deffn
6562
6563 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6564 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6565 effective after the next power cycle.
6566 @quotation Attention
6567 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6568 @end quotation
6569 Examples:
6570 @example
6571 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6572 @end example
6573 @end deffn
6574 @end deffn
6575
6576 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6577 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6578 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6579 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6580
6581 @example
6582 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6583 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6584 @end example
6585
6586 @itemize @bullet
6587 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6588 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6589 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6590 @end itemize
6591
6592 Example usage:
6593 @example
6594 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6595 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6596 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6597 @} else @{
6598 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6599 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6600 @}
6601 @end example
6602 @end deffn
6603
6604 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6605 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6606 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6607 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6608 Main program flash starts at address 0. The information flash region on
6609 MSP432P4 versions starts at address 0x200000.
6610
6611 @example
6612 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6613 @end example
6614
6615 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} bank_id [main|all]
6616 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6617 only the main program flash.
6618
6619 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6620 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6621 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6622 @end deffn
6623
6624 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} bank_id [unlock|lock]
6625 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6626 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6627 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6628
6629 To erase and program the BSL:
6630 @example
6631 msp432 bsl unlock
6632 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6633 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6634 msp432 bsl lock
6635 @end example
6636 @end deffn
6637 @end deffn
6638
6639 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6640 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6641 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6642 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6643 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6644 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6645 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6646 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6647 also have division into regions: main and info.
6648 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6649 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6650
6651 @example
6652 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6653 @end example
6654
6655 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6656
6657 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6658 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6659 @end deffn
6660
6661 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6662 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6663 @end deffn
6664
6665 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6666 Erase all userflash including info region.
6667 @end deffn
6668
6669 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6670 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6671 @end deffn
6672
6673 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6674 Check sectors protect.
6675 @end deffn
6676
6677 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6678 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6679 @end deffn
6680
6681 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6682 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6683 @end deffn
6684
6685 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6686 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6687 @end deffn
6688
6689 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6690 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6691 @end deffn
6692
6693 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6694 Show information about flash driver.
6695 @end deffn
6696
6697 @end deffn
6698
6699 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6700 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6701 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6702 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6703 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6704
6705 @example
6706 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6707 @end example
6708
6709 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6710
6711 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6712 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6713 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6714 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6715 code.
6716 @end deffn
6717
6718 @deffn Command {nrf5 info}
6719 Decodes and shows information from FICR and UICR registers.
6720 @end deffn
6721
6722 @end deffn
6723
6724 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6725 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6726 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6727
6728 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6729 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6730 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6731 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6732
6733 @example
6734 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6735 @end example
6736 @end deffn
6737
6738 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6739 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6740 and integrate flash memory.
6741
6742 @example
6743 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6744 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6745 @end example
6746
6747 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6748 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6749 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6750 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6751 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6752 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6753 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6754 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6755 @end deffn
6756 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6757 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6758 This will remove any Code Protection.
6759 @end deffn
6760 @end deffn
6761
6762 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6763 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6764 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6765 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6766 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6767
6768 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6769 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6770
6771 @example
6772 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6773 @end example
6774
6775 psoc4-specific commands
6776 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6777 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6778
6779 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6780 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6781
6782 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6783 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6784 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6785
6786 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6787 @end deffn
6788
6789 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6790 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6791
6792 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6793 @end deffn
6794 @end deffn
6795
6796 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6797 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6798 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6799 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6800 apart from the base address.
6801
6802 @example
6803 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6804 @end example
6805
6806 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6807 @quotation Attention
6808 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6809 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6810 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6811 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6812 @end quotation
6813
6814 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6815
6816 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6817 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6818 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6819 @end deffn
6820 @end deffn
6821
6822 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6823 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6824 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6825 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6826 apart from the base address.
6827
6828 @example
6829 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 \
6830 $_TARGETNAME
6831 @end example
6832 @end deffn
6833
6834 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6835 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6836 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6837 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6838
6839 @example
6840 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6841 @end example
6842
6843 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6844
6845 @itemize
6846 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6847 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6848 @end itemize
6849
6850 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6851
6852 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6853 @quotation Attention
6854 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6855 after successful write.
6856 @end quotation
6857 @end deffn
6858
6859 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6860 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6861 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6862 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6863
6864 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6865 @itemize @bullet
6866 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6867 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6868 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6869 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6870 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6871 row size: 512 bytes.
6872 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6873 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6874 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6875 operation will erase row automatically.
6876 @end itemize
6877
6878 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6879 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6880
6881 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6882
6883 @example
6884 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6885 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6886 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6887 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6888 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6889 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6890 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6891 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6892 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6893 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6894 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6895 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6896
6897 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 \
6898 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6899 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 \
6900 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6901 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 \
6902 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6903 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 \
6904 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6905 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 \
6906 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6907 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 \
6908 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6909 @end example
6910
6911 psoc6-specific commands
6912 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6913 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6914 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6915 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6916 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6917 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6918 @end deffn
6919
6920 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6921 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6922 by @command{flash banks}.
6923 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6924 @end deffn
6925 @end deffn
6926
6927 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6928 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6929 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6930 and SWD interface.
6931 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6932 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6933
6934 @example
6935 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6936 @end example
6937
6938 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6939
6940 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6941 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6942 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6943 @end deffn
6944
6945 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6946 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6947 @end deffn
6948 @end deffn
6949
6950 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6951 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6952 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6953 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6954 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6955
6956 @example
6957 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6958 @end example
6959
6960 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6961 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6962 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6963 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6964 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6965 disabled.
6966
6967 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6968 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6969 @quotation Warning
6970 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6971 applied to all of them.
6972 @end quotation
6973 @end deffn
6974 @end deffn
6975
6976 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6977 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6978 from STMicroelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6979 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6980 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6981
6982 @example
6983 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6984 @end example
6985
6986 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6987 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6988 the flash driver.
6989
6990 @example
6991 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6992 @end example
6993
6994 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6995 as per the following example.
6996 @example
6997 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6998 @end example
6999
7000 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
7001
7002 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
7003 Locks the entire stm32 device against reading.
7004 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7005 @end deffn
7006
7007 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
7008 Unlocks the entire stm32 device for reading. This command will cause
7009 a mass erase of the entire stm32 device if previously locked.
7010 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7011 @end deffn
7012
7013 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
7014 Mass erases the entire stm32 device.
7015 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7016 @end deffn
7017
7018 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
7019 Reads and displays active stm32 option bytes loaded during POR
7020 or upon executing the @command{stm32f1x options_load} command.
7021 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7022 @end deffn
7023
7024 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP}) (@option{USEROPT} user_data)
7025 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
7026 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7027 The @var{user_data} parameter is content of higher 16 bits of the option byte register (Data0 and Data1 as one 16bit number).
7028 @end deffn
7029
7030 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_load} num
7031 Generates a special kind of reset to re-load the stm32 option bytes written
7032 by the @command{stm32f1x options_write} or @command{flash protect} commands
7033 without having to power cycle the target. Not applicable to stm32f1x devices.
7034 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7035 @end deffn
7036 @end deffn
7037
7038 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
7039 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7040 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
7041 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7042 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7043
7044 @example
7045 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7046 @end example
7047
7048 If you use OTP (One-Time Programmable) memory define it as a second bank
7049 as per the following example.
7050 @example
7051 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0x1FFF7800 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7052 @end example
7053
7054 @deffn Command {stm32f2x otp } num (@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{show})
7055 Enables or disables OTP write commands for bank @var{num}.
7056 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7057 @end deffn
7058
7059 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7060 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7061 the flash driver.
7062
7063 @example
7064 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7065 @end example
7066
7067 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
7068
7069 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
7070 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7071 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7072 @end deffn
7073
7074 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
7075 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7076 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7077 @end deffn
7078
7079 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
7080 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
7081 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7082 @end deffn
7083
7084 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
7085 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
7086 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7087 @end deffn
7088
7089 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
7090 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
7091 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
7092 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
7093 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
7094 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
7095 @end deffn
7096
7097 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
7098 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
7099 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
7100 @end deffn
7101 @end deffn
7102
7103 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
7104 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7105 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
7106 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7107 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7108
7109 @example
7110 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7111 @end example
7112
7113 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7114 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7115 the flash driver.
7116
7117 @example
7118 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7119 @end example
7120
7121 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
7122
7123 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
7124 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7125 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7126 @end deffn
7127
7128 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
7129 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7130 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7131 @end deffn
7132
7133 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
7134 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
7135 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7136 @end deffn
7137
7138 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_read} num reg_offset
7139 Reads an option byte register from the stm32h7x device.
7140 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7141 is the register offset of the option byte to read from the used bank registers' base.
7142 For example: in STM32H74x/H75x the bank 1 registers' base is 0x52002000 and 0x52002100 for bank 2.
7143
7144 Example usage:
7145 @example
7146 # read OPTSR_CUR
7147 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x1c
7148 # read WPSN_CUR1R
7149 stm32h7x option_read 0 0x38
7150 # read WPSN_CUR2R
7151 stm32h7x option_read 1 0x38
7152 @end example
7153 @end deffn
7154
7155 @deffn Command {stm32h7x option_write} num reg_offset value [reg_mask]
7156 Writes an option byte register of the stm32h7x device.
7157 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7158 is the register offset of the option byte to write from the used bank register base,
7159 and @var{reg_mask} is the mask to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1'
7160 will be touched).
7161
7162 Example usage:
7163 @example
7164 # swap bank 1 and bank 2 in dual bank devices
7165 # by setting SWAP_BANK_OPT bit in OPTSR_PRG
7166 stm32h7x option_write 0 0x20 0x8000000 0x8000000
7167 @end example
7168 @end deffn
7169 @end deffn
7170
7171 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
7172 All members of the STM32L0 and STM32L1 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics
7173 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
7174 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7175 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7176
7177 @example
7178 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7179 @end example
7180
7181 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7182 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7183 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
7184 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
7185 second bank.
7186
7187 @example
7188 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7189 @end example
7190
7191 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
7192
7193 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
7194 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7195 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7196 @end deffn
7197
7198 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
7199 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7200 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7201 @end deffn
7202
7203 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
7204 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
7205 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
7206 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
7207 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7208 @end deffn
7209 @end deffn
7210
7211 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
7212 All members of the STM32 G0, G4, L4, L4+, L5, WB and WL
7213 microcontroller families from STMicroelectronics include internal flash
7214 and use ARM Cortex-M0+, M4 and M33 cores.
7215 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
7216 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
7217
7218 @example
7219 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7220 @end example
7221
7222 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
7223 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
7224 the flash driver. However, specifying a wrong value might lead to a completely
7225 wrong flash layout, so this feature must be used carefully.
7226
7227 @example
7228 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7229 @end example
7230
7231 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
7232
7233 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
7234 Locks the entire stm32 device.
7235 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7236 @end deffn
7237
7238 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
7239 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
7240 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7241 @end deffn
7242
7243 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
7244 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
7245 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7246 @end deffn
7247
7248 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
7249 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
7250 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7251 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
7252
7253 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
7254 @example
7255 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
7256 # Option Register (for STM32L4x): <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
7257 # Option Register (for STM32WBx): <0x58004020> = ...
7258 # The correct flash base address will be used automatically
7259 @end example
7260
7261 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
7262 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
7263 @end deffn
7264
7265 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
7266 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
7267 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
7268 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
7269 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
7270
7271 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
7272 @example
7273 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
7274 @end example
7275
7276 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
7277 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
7278 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
7279 @end deffn
7280
7281 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
7282 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a system reset of the device.
7283 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7284 @end deffn
7285 @end deffn
7286
7287 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
7288 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7289 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7290 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
7291 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
7292
7293 @example
7294 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
7295 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
7296 @end example
7297
7298 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
7299 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
7300 for the specified flash bank.
7301 @end deffn
7302 @end deffn
7303
7304 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
7305 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from STMicroelectronics
7306 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
7307 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
7308 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
7309
7310 @example
7311 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7312 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
7313 @end example
7314
7315 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
7316 Configures the str9 flash controller.
7317 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
7318
7319 @itemize @bullet
7320 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
7321 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
7322 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7323 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
7324 @end itemize
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @end deffn
7328
7329 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
7330 @cindex str9xpec
7331
7332 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
7333 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
7334 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
7335 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
7336
7337 Here is some background info to help
7338 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
7339 the str9:
7340 @enumerate
7341 @item
7342 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
7343 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
7344 @item
7345 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
7346 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
7347 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
7348 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
7349 @end enumerate
7350
7351 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
7352 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
7353 configured for flash bank 0.
7354 @example
7355 # assert srst, we do not want core running
7356 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
7357 adapter assert srst
7358 # turn off target polling
7359 poll off
7360 # disable str9 core
7361 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
7362 # read option bytes
7363 str9xpec options_read 0
7364 # re-enable str9 core
7365 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
7366 poll on
7367 reset halt
7368 @end example
7369 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
7370 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
7371 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
7372 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
7373
7374 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
7375
7376 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
7377 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
7378 @end deffn
7379
7380 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
7381 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
7382 directly to the embedded flash controller.
7383 @end deffn
7384
7385 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
7386 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
7387 erase the device.
7388 @end deffn
7389
7390 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
7391 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
7392 @end deffn
7393
7394 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
7395 Configure str9 boot bank.
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7399 Configure str9 lvd source.
7400 @end deffn
7401
7402 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
7403 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
7404 @end deffn
7405
7406 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
7407 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
7408 @end deffn
7409
7410 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
7411 Read str9 option bytes.
7412 @end deffn
7413
7414 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
7415 Write str9 option bytes.
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
7419 unlock str9 device.
7420 @end deffn
7421
7422 @end deffn
7423
7424 @deffn {Flash Driver} swm050
7425 @cindex swm050
7426 All members of the swm050 microcontroller family from Foshan Synwit Tech.
7427
7428 @example
7429 flash bank $_FLASHNAME swm050 0x0 0x2000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
7430 @end example
7431
7432 One swm050-specific command is defined:
7433
7434 @deffn Command {swm050 mass_erase} bank_id
7435 Erases the entire flash bank.
7436 @end deffn
7437
7438 @end deffn
7439
7440
7441 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
7442 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
7443 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
7444 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7445
7446 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
7447
7448 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
7449 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
7450 @end deffn
7451
7452 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
7453 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
7454 @end deffn
7455
7456 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
7457 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
7458 the flash clock.
7459 @end deffn
7460 @end deffn
7461
7462 @deffn {Flash Driver} w600
7463 W60x series Wi-Fi SoC from WinnerMicro
7464 are designed with ARM Cortex-M3 and have 1M Byte QFLASH inside.
7465 The @var{w600} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
7466 correct bank config.
7467
7468 @example
7469 flash bank $_FLASHNAME w600 0x08000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAMEs
7470 @end example
7471 @end deffn
7472
7473 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
7474 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7475 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7476 @end deffn
7477
7478 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
7479 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
7480 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
7481
7482 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
7483
7484 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
7485 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
7486 @end deffn
7487
7488 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
7489 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
7490 @end deffn
7491
7492 @end deffn
7493
7494 @section NAND Flash Commands
7495 @cindex NAND
7496
7497 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
7498 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
7499 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
7500
7501 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
7502 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
7503 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
7504 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
7505 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
7506 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
7507
7508 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
7509 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
7510 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
7511 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
7512 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
7513 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
7514 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
7515 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
7516 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
7517 with techniques such as wear leveling.
7518
7519 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
7520 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
7521 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
7522 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
7523 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
7524 every 512 bytes of data.
7525
7526 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
7527 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
7528 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
7529 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
7530 ECC mode is used.
7531
7532 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
7533 @enumerate
7534 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
7535 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
7536 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
7537 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
7538 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
7539 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
7540 to access that device.
7541 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
7542 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
7543 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
7544 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
7545 de-brick a board.
7546 @end enumerate
7547
7548 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
7549 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
7550 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
7551 are only 32 bits wide.
7552 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
7553 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
7554 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
7555 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
7556
7557 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
7558 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
7559 @cindex NAND configuration
7560
7561 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
7562 plus some additional configuration that's done after
7563 OpenOCD has initialized.
7564
7565 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
7566 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
7567 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
7568 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
7569 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
7570 they were a single (larger) device.
7571 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
7572 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
7573
7574 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
7575 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
7576 configuration files, not interactively.
7577
7578 @itemize @bullet
7579 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
7580 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
7581 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
7582 associated with the NAND device being declared.
7583 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
7584 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
7585 commands to the NAND controller.
7586 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
7587 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
7588 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
7589 for more information.
7590 @end itemize
7591 @end deffn
7592
7593 @deffn Command {nand list}
7594 Prints a summary of each device declared
7595 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
7596 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
7597 @example
7598 > nand list
7599 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7600 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7601 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
7602 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
7603 >
7604 @end example
7605 @end deffn
7606
7607 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
7608 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
7609 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
7610 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7611 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
7612 it with most other NAND commands.
7613 @end deffn
7614
7615 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
7616
7617 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
7618 @cindex NAND reading
7619 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
7620 starting at the specified offset.
7621 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7622
7623 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7624 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7625
7626 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
7627 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
7628 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
7629
7630 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
7631 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
7632 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
7633 method which handled that error correction.
7634
7635 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
7636 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
7637 @itemize @bullet
7638 @item no oob_* parameter
7639 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
7640 @item @code{oob_raw}
7641 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
7642 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
7643 spare areas associated with each data page.
7644 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
7645 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
7646 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
7647 @item @code{oob_only}
7648 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
7649 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
7650 spare areas associated with each data page.
7651 @end itemize
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7655 @cindex NAND erasing
7656 @cindex NAND programming
7657 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7658 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7659 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7660 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7661 If those parameters are not specified,
7662 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7663 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7664
7665 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7666 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7667 block marker.
7668 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7669 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7670 @end deffn
7671
7672 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7673 @cindex NAND writing
7674 @cindex NAND programming
7675 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7676 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7677 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7678 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7679
7680 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7681 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7682
7683 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7684 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7685 past the end of the device.
7686 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7687 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7688 if that's being written.)
7689
7690 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7691 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7692 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7693
7694 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7695 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7696 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7697 @itemize @bullet
7698 @item no oob_* parameter
7699 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7700 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7701 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7702 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7703 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7704 @item @code{oob_only}
7705 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7706 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7707 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7708 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7709 @item @code{oob_raw}
7710 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7711 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7712 un-altered OOB.
7713 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7714 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7715 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7716 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7717 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7718 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7719 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7720 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7721 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7722 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7723 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7724 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7725 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7726 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7727 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7728 @end itemize
7729 @end deffn
7730
7731 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7732 @cindex NAND verification
7733 @cindex NAND programming
7734 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7735 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7736 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7737
7738 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7739 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7740
7741 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7742 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7743 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7744 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7745 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7746
7747 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7748 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7749 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7750
7751 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7752 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7753 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7754 be removed in a future release.
7755 @end deffn
7756
7757 @subsection Other NAND commands
7758 @cindex NAND other commands
7759
7760 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7761 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7762 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7763 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7764 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7765 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7766 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7767 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7768
7769 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7770 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7771 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7772 @end deffn
7773
7774 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7775 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7776 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7777 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7778 status for each block.
7779 @end deffn
7780
7781 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7782 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7783 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7784
7785 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7786 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7787 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7788 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7789 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7790
7791 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7792 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7793 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7794 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7795 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7796 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7797 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7798 @end deffn
7799
7800 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7801 @subsection NAND Driver List
7802 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7803 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7804 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7805
7806 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7807 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7808 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7809 address of the ECC controller.
7810 @example
7811 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7812 @end example
7813 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7814 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7815 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7816 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7817 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7818 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7819 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7820 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7821 @end deffn
7822 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7823 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7824 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7825 @end deffn
7826
7827 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7828 properly configured for input or output.
7829 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7830 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7831 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7832 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7833 @end deffn
7834 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7835 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7836 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7837 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7838 @end deffn
7839 @end deffn
7840
7841 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7842 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7843 chips from Texas Instruments.
7844 It takes three extra parameters:
7845 address of the NAND chip;
7846 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7847 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7848 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7849 @example
7850 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7851 @end example
7852 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7853 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7854 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7855 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7856 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7857 @end deffn
7858
7859 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7860 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7861 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7862 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7863 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7864 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7865 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7866 @end deffn
7867
7868 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7869 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7870 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7871 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7872 @end deffn
7873 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7874
7875 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7876 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7877 should work for this chip as well.
7878 @end deffn
7879
7880 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7881 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7882 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7883 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7884 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7885 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7886 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7887 @example
7888 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7889 @end example
7890 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7891 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7892 without parameter query status.
7893 @end deffn
7894 @end deffn
7895
7896 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7897 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7898 parameter: the address of the controller.
7899 @example
7900 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7901 @end example
7902 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7903 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7904 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7905 change any behavior.
7906 @end deffn
7907
7908 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7909 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7910 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7911 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7912 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7913 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7914 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7915 specialized commands.
7916 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7917 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7918 change any behavior.
7919 @end deffn
7920
7921 @node Flash Programming
7922 @chapter Flash Programming
7923
7924 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7925 Programming can be achieved by either using @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7926 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7927
7928 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7929 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7930
7931 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7932 @enumerate
7933 @item 'init' is executed.
7934 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7935 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7936 @item If the @option{preverify} parameter is given, the target is "verified" first and only flashed if this fails.
7937 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7938 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7939 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7940 @end enumerate
7941
7942 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7943
7944 @example
7945 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7946 # are optional parameters
7947 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7948 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7949
7950 # binary files need the flash address passing
7951 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7952 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7953 @end example
7954
7955 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7956 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7957 @cindex PLD
7958 @cindex FPGA
7959
7960 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7961 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7962 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7963 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7964 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7965 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7966 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7967
7968 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7969
7970 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7971 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7972 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7973
7974 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7975 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7976
7977 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7978 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7979 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7980 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7981 behavior.
7982 @end deffn
7983
7984 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7985 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7986 @end deffn
7987
7988 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7989 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7990 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7991 @end deffn
7992
7993 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7994
7995 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7996 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7997 that particular type of PLD.
7998
7999 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
8000 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
8001 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
8002
8003 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
8004 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
8005 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
8006
8007 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
8008 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
8009 for FPGA @var{num}.
8010 @end deffn
8011 @end deffn
8012
8013 @node General Commands
8014 @chapter General Commands
8015 @cindex commands
8016
8017 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
8018 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
8019 commands are documented elsewhere.
8020
8021 Intent:
8022 @itemize @bullet
8023 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
8024 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
8025 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
8026 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
8027
8028 @item @b{From the human}
8029 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
8030 or via GDB (default port 3333).
8031
8032 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
8033 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
8034 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
8035
8036 @item @b{Machine Interface}
8037 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
8038 port is 5555.
8039 @end itemize
8040
8041
8042 @section Server Commands
8043
8044 @deffn {Command} exit
8045 Exits the current telnet session.
8046 @end deffn
8047
8048 @deffn {Command} help [string]
8049 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
8050 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
8051 Not every command provides helptext.
8052
8053 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
8054 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
8055 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
8056 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
8057 @end deffn
8058
8059 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
8060 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
8061 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
8062 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
8063 Useful in connection with script files
8064 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
8065 @end deffn
8066
8067 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
8068 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
8069 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
8070 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
8071
8072 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
8073 @example
8074 # redefine shutdown
8075 rename shutdown original_shutdown
8076 proc shutdown @{@} @{
8077 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
8078 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
8079 original_shutdown
8080 @}
8081 @end example
8082 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
8083 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @anchor{debuglevel}
8087 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
8088 @cindex message level
8089 Display debug level.
8090 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
8091 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
8092 Level 0 is error messages only;
8093 level 1 adds warnings;
8094 level 2 adds informational messages;
8095 level 3 adds debugging messages;
8096 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
8097 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
8098 the command line along with the location of that log
8099 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
8100 @xref{Running}.
8101 @end deffn
8102
8103 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
8104 Logs a message at "user" priority.
8105 Output @var{message} to stdout.
8106 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
8107 @example
8108 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
8109 @end example
8110 @end deffn
8111
8112 @deffn Command log_output [filename | "default"]
8113 Redirect logging to @var{filename} or set it back to default output;
8114 the default log output channel is stderr.
8115 @end deffn
8116
8117 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
8118 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
8122 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
8123 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
8124 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
8125 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
8126 @end deffn
8127
8128 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
8129 @section Target State handling
8130 @cindex reset
8131 @cindex halt
8132 @cindex target initialization
8133
8134 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
8135 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
8136 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
8137 a current target which is used to perform the
8138 various operations. The current target may be changed
8139 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
8140 target which should become current.
8141
8142 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
8143 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
8144 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
8145 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
8146 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
8147
8148 @emph{With no arguments}:
8149 list all available registers for the current target,
8150 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
8151 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
8152 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
8153 are flagged as such.
8154
8155 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
8156 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
8157 bypassing any internal cache.
8158
8159 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
8160 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
8161 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
8162 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
8163 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
8164 relevant module will flush such values.
8165
8166 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
8167 Debug and trace infrastructure:
8168
8169 @example
8170 > reg
8171 ===== ARM registers
8172 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
8173 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
8174 (2) r2 (/32)
8175 ...
8176 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
8177 >
8178 @end example
8179 @end deffn
8180
8181 @deffn Command halt [ms]
8182 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
8183 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
8184 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
8185 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
8186 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
8187 (and enter debug mode).
8188 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
8189
8190 @quotation Warning
8191 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
8192 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
8193 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
8194 power mode by gating the core clock;
8195 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
8196
8197 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
8198 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
8199 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
8200 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
8201 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
8202 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
8203
8204 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
8205 work with a JTAG debugger.
8206 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
8207 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
8208 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
8209 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
8210 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
8211 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
8212 @end quotation
8213
8214 @end deffn
8215
8216 @deffn Command resume [address]
8217 Resume the target at its current code position,
8218 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8219 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
8220 @end deffn
8221
8222 @deffn Command step [address]
8223 Single-step the target at its current code position,
8224 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
8225 @end deffn
8226
8227 @anchor{resetcommand}
8228 @deffn Command reset
8229 @deffnx Command {reset run}
8230 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
8231 @deffnx Command {reset init}
8232 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
8233 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
8234 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
8235
8236 The optional parameter specifies what should
8237 happen after the reset.
8238 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
8239 The other options will not work on all systems.
8240 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8241
8242 @itemize @minus
8243 @item @b{run} Let the target run
8244 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
8245 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
8246 @end itemize
8247 @end deffn
8248
8249 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
8250 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
8251 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
8252 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
8253 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
8254 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
8255 state.
8256 @end deffn
8257
8258 @deffn Command {adapter assert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8259 @deffnx Command {adapter deassert} [signal [assert|deassert signal]]
8260 Set values of reset signals.
8261 Without parameters returns current status of the signals.
8262 The @var{signal} parameter values may be
8263 @option{srst}, indicating that srst signal is to be asserted or deasserted,
8264 @option{trst}, indicating that trst signal is to be asserted or deasserted.
8265
8266 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
8267 to configure how the board and the adapter treat these two
8268 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
8269 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
8270 Trying to assert a signal that is not present triggers an error.
8271 If a signal is present on the adapter and not specified in the command,
8272 the signal will not be modified.
8273
8274 @quotation Note
8275 TRST is specially handled.
8276 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
8277 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
8278 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
8279 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
8280 instead of the TRST signal.
8281 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
8282 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
8283 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
8284 with handlers for that event.
8285 @end quotation
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @section I/O Utilities
8289
8290 These commands are available when
8291 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
8292 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
8293 notably the ZY1000.
8294 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
8295
8296 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
8297
8298 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
8299 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
8300 the text file @file{filename}.
8301 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
8302 The last string is followed by a newline.
8303 @end deffn
8304
8305 @deffn Command cat filename
8306 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
8307 @end deffn
8308
8309 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
8310 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
8311 into @file{dest_filename}.
8312 @end deffn
8313
8314 @deffn Command ip
8315 @emph{No description provided.}
8316 @end deffn
8317
8318 @deffn Command ls
8319 @emph{No description provided.}
8320 @end deffn
8321
8322 @deffn Command mac
8323 @emph{No description provided.}
8324 @end deffn
8325
8326 @deffn Command meminfo
8327 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
8328 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
8329 @end deffn
8330
8331 @deffn Command peek
8332 @emph{No description provided.}
8333 @end deffn
8334
8335 @deffn Command poke
8336 @emph{No description provided.}
8337 @end deffn
8338
8339 @deffn Command rm filename
8340 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
8341 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
8342 @end deffn
8343
8344 @deffn Command trunc filename
8345 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
8346 @end deffn
8347
8348 @anchor{memoryaccess}
8349 @section Memory access commands
8350 @cindex memory access
8351
8352 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
8353 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
8354 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
8355 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
8356
8357 @enumerate
8358 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
8359 to change the current target.
8360 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
8361 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
8362 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
8363 @end enumerate
8364
8365 @deffn Command mdd [phys] addr [count]
8366 @deffnx Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
8367 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
8368 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
8369 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
8370 64-bit doublewords (@command{mdd}),
8371 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
8372 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
8373 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8374 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8375 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8376 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8377 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
8378 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
8379 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
8380 @end deffn
8381
8382 @deffn Command mwd [phys] addr doubleword [count]
8383 @deffnx Command mww [phys] addr word [count]
8384 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword [count]
8385 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte [count]
8386 Writes the specified @var{doubleword} (64 bits), @var{word} (32 bits),
8387 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
8388 at the specified address @var{addr}.
8389 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
8390 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
8391 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
8392 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
8393 If @var{count} is specified, fills that many units of consecutive address.
8394 @end deffn
8395
8396 @anchor{imageaccess}
8397 @section Image loading commands
8398 @cindex image loading
8399 @cindex image dumping
8400
8401 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
8402 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
8403 binary file named @var{filename}.
8404 @end deffn
8405
8406 @deffn Command {fast_load}
8407 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
8408 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
8409 @end deffn
8410
8411 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
8412 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
8413 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
8414 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
8415 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
8416 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
8417 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
8418 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
8419 separately.
8420 @end deffn
8421
8422 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
8423 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
8424 The file format may optionally be specified
8425 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
8426 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
8427 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
8428 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
8429 @example
8430 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
8431 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
8432 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
8433 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
8434 $address $length
8435 @}
8436 @end example
8437 @end deffn
8438
8439 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
8440 Displays image section sizes and addresses
8441 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
8442 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
8443 The file format may optionally be specified
8444 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8445 @end deffn
8446
8447 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8448 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8449 The file format may optionally be specified
8450 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8451 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
8452 @end deffn
8453
8454 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
8455 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
8456 The file format may optionally be specified
8457 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
8458 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
8459 @end deffn
8460
8461
8462 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
8463 @cindex breakpoint
8464 @cindex watchpoint
8465
8466 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
8467 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
8468 watchpoints.
8469 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
8470
8471 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
8472 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
8473 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
8474 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8475 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
8476 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
8477
8478 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
8479 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
8480 @end deffn
8481
8482 @deffn Command {rbp} @option{all} | address
8483 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address} or all breakpoints.
8484 @end deffn
8485
8486 @deffn Command {rwp} address
8487 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
8488 @end deffn
8489
8490 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
8491 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
8492 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
8493 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
8494 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
8495 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
8496 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
8497 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
8498 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
8499 @end deffn
8500
8501
8502 @section Real Time Transfer (RTT)
8503
8504 Real Time Transfer (RTT) is an interface specified by SEGGER based on basic
8505 memory reads and writes to transfer data bidirectionally between target and host.
8506 The specification is independent of the target architecture.
8507 Every target that supports so called "background memory access", which means
8508 that the target memory can be accessed by the debugger while the target is
8509 running, can be used.
8510 This interface is especially of interest for targets without
8511 Serial Wire Output (SWO), such as ARM Cortex-M0, or where semihosting is not
8512 applicable because of real-time constraints.
8513
8514 @quotation Note
8515 The current implementation supports only single target devices.
8516 @end quotation
8517
8518 The data transfer between host and target device is organized through
8519 unidirectional up/down-channels for target-to-host and host-to-target
8520 communication, respectively.
8521
8522 @quotation Note
8523 The current implementation does not respect channel buffer flags.
8524 They are used to determine what happens when writing to a full buffer, for
8525 example.
8526 @end quotation
8527
8528 Channels are exposed via raw TCP/IP connections. One or more RTT servers can be
8529 assigned to each channel to make them accessible to an unlimited number
8530 of TCP/IP connections.
8531
8532 @deffn Command {rtt setup} address size ID
8533 Configure RTT for the currently selected target.
8534 Once RTT is started, OpenOCD searches for a control block with the
8535 identifier @var{ID} starting at the memory address @var{address} within the next
8536 @var{size} bytes.
8537 @end deffn
8538
8539 @deffn Command {rtt start}
8540 Start RTT.
8541 If the control block location is not known, OpenOCD starts searching for it.
8542 @end deffn
8543
8544 @deffn Command {rtt stop}
8545 Stop RTT.
8546 @end deffn
8547
8548 @deffn Command {rtt polling_interval [interval]}
8549 Display the polling interval.
8550 If @var{interval} is provided, set the polling interval.
8551 The polling interval determines (in milliseconds) how often the up-channels are
8552 checked for new data.
8553 @end deffn
8554
8555 @deffn Command {rtt channels}
8556 Display a list of all channels and their properties.
8557 @end deffn
8558
8559 @deffn Command {rtt channellist}
8560 Return a list of all channels and their properties as Tcl list.
8561 The list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
8562 @end deffn
8563
8564 @deffn Command {rtt server start} port channel
8565 Start a TCP server on @var{port} for the channel @var{channel}.
8566 @end deffn
8567
8568 @deffn Command {rtt server stop} port
8569 Stop the TCP sever with port @var{port}.
8570 @end deffn
8571
8572 The following example shows how to setup RTT using the SEGGER RTT implementation
8573 on the target device.
8574
8575 @example
8576 resume
8577
8578 rtt setup 0x20000000 2048 "SEGGER RTT"
8579 rtt start
8580
8581 rtt server start 9090 0
8582 @end example
8583
8584 In this example, OpenOCD searches the control block with the ID "SEGGER RTT"
8585 starting at 0x20000000 for 2048 bytes. The RTT channel 0 is exposed through the
8586 TCP/IP port 9090.
8587
8588
8589 @section Misc Commands
8590
8591 @cindex profiling
8592 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
8593 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
8594 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
8595 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
8596 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
8597 limit the address range.
8598 @end deffn
8599
8600 @deffn Command {version}
8601 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
8602 @end deffn
8603
8604 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
8605 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
8606 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
8607 @end deffn
8608
8609 @node Architecture and Core Commands
8610 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
8611 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
8612 @cindex Core Specific Commands
8613
8614 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
8615 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
8616 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
8617 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
8618
8619 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
8620 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
8621 @cindex tracing
8622 @cindex ETM
8623 @cindex ETB
8624
8625 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
8626 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
8627 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
8628
8629 @itemize
8630 @item
8631 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
8632 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
8633 supports such an interface.
8634 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
8635 and trace port support.)
8636 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
8637 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
8638 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
8639 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
8640 in the board-specific configuration file.
8641 @item
8642 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
8643 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
8644 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
8645 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
8646 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
8647 @end itemize
8648
8649 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
8650
8651 @quotation Issues
8652 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
8653 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
8654
8655 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
8656 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
8657 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
8658 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
8659 dummy trace port driver}.
8660
8661 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
8662 as well as tracing only during specific states
8663 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
8664
8665 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
8666 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
8667 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
8668 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
8669 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
8670
8671 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
8672 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
8673 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
8674 this original style of JTAG access.
8675 @end quotation
8676
8677 @subsection ETM Configuration
8678 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
8679
8680 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
8681 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
8682 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
8683
8684 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
8685 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
8686 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
8687 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
8688 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
8689 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
8690 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
8691 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
8692 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
8693
8694 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
8695 or @option{demultiplexed}.
8696 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
8697
8698 @quotation Warning
8699 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
8700 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
8701 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
8702 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
8703 @end quotation
8704
8705 @quotation Note
8706 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
8707 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
8708 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
8709 what CPU activities are traced.
8710 @end quotation
8711 @end deffn
8712
8713 @deffn Command {etm info}
8714 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
8715 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
8716 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8717 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8718 @end deffn
8719
8720 @deffn Command {etm status}
8721 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8722 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8723 Did trace data overflow?
8724 Was it triggered?
8725 @end deffn
8726
8727 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8728 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8729 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8730 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8731 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8732
8733 @itemize
8734 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8735 when they pass any ViewData filtering that was set up.
8736 The value is one of
8737 @option{none} (save nothing),
8738 @option{data} (save data),
8739 @option{address} (save addresses),
8740 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8741 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8742 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8743 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8744 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8745 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8746 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8747 trace stream without an image of the code.
8748 @end itemize
8749 @end deffn
8750
8751 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8752 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8753 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8754 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8755 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8756
8757 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8758 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8759 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8760 @end deffn
8761
8762 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8763
8764 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8765 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8766 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8767
8768 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8769 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8770 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8771 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8772 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8773 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8774 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8775
8776 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8777
8778 @itemize
8779 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8780 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8781 for instruction access within that function's body.
8782 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8783 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8784 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8785 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8786 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8787 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8788 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8789 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8790 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8791 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8792 @item @emph{... more}
8793 @end itemize
8794
8795 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8796 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8797
8798 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8799 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8800 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8801 @end deffn
8802
8803 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8804 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8805 @end deffn
8806
8807 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8808 Opens an image file.
8809 @end deffn
8810
8811 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8812 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8813 @end deffn
8814
8815 @deffn Command {etm start}
8816 Starts trace data collection.
8817 @end deffn
8818
8819 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8820 Stops trace data collection.
8821 @end deffn
8822
8823 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8824 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8825
8826 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8827
8828 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8829 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8830 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8831 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8832 any trace data collection.}
8833 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8834 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8835 @end deffn
8836 @end deffn
8837
8838 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8839 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8840 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8841 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8842 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8843 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8844 @end deffn
8845 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8846 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8847 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8848 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8849 trace trigger becomes active.
8850
8851 @itemize
8852 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8853 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8854 afterwards.
8855 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8856 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8857 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8858 what caused that event to happen.
8859 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8860 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8861 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8862 how the event caused trouble.
8863 @end itemize
8864 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8865 @end deffn
8866
8867 @end deffn
8868
8869 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8870 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8871 @cindex CTI
8872
8873 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8874 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8875 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8876 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8877 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8878 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8879
8880 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-baseaddr} base_address
8881 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8882 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8883 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8884 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8885 including additional configuration.
8886 @end deffn
8887
8888 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8889 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8890 @end deffn
8891
8892 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8893 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8894 @end deffn
8895
8896 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8897 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8898 @end deffn
8899
8900 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8901 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8902 @end deffn
8903
8904 @deffn Command {$cti_name ack} @var{event}
8905 Acknowledge a CTI @var{event}.
8906 @end deffn
8907
8908 @deffn Command {$cti_name channel} @var{channel_number} @var{operation}
8909 Perform a specific channel operation, the possible operations are:
8910 gate, ungate, set, clear and pulse
8911 @end deffn
8912
8913 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8914 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8915 of the CTI.
8916 @end deffn
8917
8918 @deffn Command {cti names}
8919 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8920 useful in TCL scripting.
8921 @end deffn
8922
8923 @section Generic ARM
8924 @cindex ARM
8925
8926 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8927 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8928 commands that may be available.
8929
8930 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8931 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8932 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8933 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8934 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8935 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8936 @end deffn
8937
8938 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8939 @cindex disassemble
8940 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8941 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8942 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8943 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8944 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8945 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8946 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8947
8948 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8949 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8950 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8951 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8952 with a handful of exceptions.
8953 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8954 @end deffn
8955
8956 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8957 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8958 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8959 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8960 and using the MCR instruction.
8961 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8962 an ARM register.)
8963 @end deffn
8964
8965 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8966 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8967 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8968 and the MRC instruction.
8969 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8970 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8971 an ARM register.)
8972 @end deffn
8973
8974 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8975 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8976 core mode if necessary.
8977 @end deffn
8978
8979 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8980 @cindex ARM semihosting
8981 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8982
8983 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8984 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8985 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8986 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8987 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8988 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8989 @end deffn
8990
8991 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8992 @cindex ARM semihosting
8993 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8994
8995 @example
8996 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8997 @end example
8998
8999 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
9000 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
9001 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
9002 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
9003 @end deffn
9004
9005 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9006 @cindex ARM semihosting
9007 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
9008 status.
9009
9010 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
9011 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
9012 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
9013 debugger.
9014 @end deffn
9015
9016 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9017 @cindex ARM semihosting
9018 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
9019
9020 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
9021 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
9022 the value returned by the target.
9023
9024 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
9025 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
9026 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
9027 encountering a break.
9028
9029 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
9030 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
9031 to the debugger.
9032 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
9033 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
9034 request or equivalent").
9035
9036 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
9037 this option (default: disabled).
9038 @end deffn
9039
9040 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
9041 @cindex ARMv4
9042 @cindex ARMv5
9043
9044 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
9045 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
9046 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
9047 variant.
9048
9049 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
9050 @cindex ARM7
9051 @cindex ARM9
9052
9053 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
9054 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
9055 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
9056 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
9057
9058 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9059 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
9060 EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
9061 instead of breakpoints.
9062 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9063
9064 This should be
9065 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
9066 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
9067 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
9068 @end deffn
9069
9070 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9071 @cindex DCC
9072 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
9073 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
9074 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9075
9076 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
9077 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
9078 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
9079 @end deffn
9080
9081 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9082 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
9083 that don't check completion of the operation.
9084 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9085
9086 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
9087 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
9088 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
9089 @end deffn
9090
9091 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
9092 @cindex ARM9
9093
9094 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
9095 integer processors.
9096 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
9097
9098 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
9099 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
9100 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
9101 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
9102
9103 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
9104 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9105 @cindex vector_catch
9106 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
9107 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
9108 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
9109 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
9110 to those hardware vectors.
9111
9112 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
9113 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
9114 vector catch hardware to intercept
9115 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
9116 @option{none} of them,
9117 or a list with one or more of the following:
9118 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
9119 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
9120 @end deffn
9121
9122 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
9123 @cindex ARM920T
9124
9125 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
9126 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
9127 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
9128 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9129 and ARM9 commands.
9130
9131 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
9132 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
9133 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
9134 @end deffn
9135
9136 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
9137 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9138 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9139 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
9140 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
9141 (Not all registers can be written.)
9142 @end deffn
9143
9144 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
9145 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
9146 @end deffn
9147
9148 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
9149 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
9150 @end deffn
9151
9152 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
9153 @cindex ARM926ej-s
9154
9155 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
9156 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
9157 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
9158 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9159 and ARM9 commands.
9160
9161 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
9162 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
9163
9164 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
9165 Print information about the caches found.
9166 @end deffn
9167
9168 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
9169 @cindex ARM966E
9170
9171 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
9172 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9173 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
9174 and ARM9 commands.
9175
9176 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
9177 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9178 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9179 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
9180 ARM966E-S TRM.
9181 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
9182 as required for BIST support.
9183 @end deffn
9184
9185 @subsection XScale specific commands
9186 @cindex XScale
9187
9188 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
9189
9190 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
9191 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
9192 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
9193 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
9194 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
9195 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
9196 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
9197
9198 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
9199 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
9200 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
9201 the mini-IC.
9202
9203 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
9204 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
9205 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
9206 code layout in memory:
9207 @example
9208 _vectors:
9209 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9210 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9211 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9212 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9213 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9214 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9215 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9216 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
9217 .org 0x100
9218 .long real_reset_vector
9219 .long real_ui_handler
9220 .long real_swi_handler
9221 .long real_pf_abort
9222 .long real_data_abort
9223 .long 0 /* unused */
9224 .long real_irq_handler
9225 .long real_fiq_handler
9226 @end example
9227
9228 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
9229 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
9230 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
9231 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
9232 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
9233 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
9234 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
9235 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
9236 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
9237 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
9238 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
9239 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
9240 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
9241 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
9242 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
9243 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
9244 software.
9245
9246 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
9247 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
9248 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
9249 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
9250
9251 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
9252 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
9253 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
9254 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
9255 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
9256 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
9257 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
9258 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
9259 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
9260
9261 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
9262 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
9263
9264 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
9265 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
9266 @end deffn
9267
9268 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
9269 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
9270 @end deffn
9271
9272 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
9273 Displays information about the CPU caches.
9274 @end deffn
9275
9276 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
9277 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
9278 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
9279 @end deffn
9280
9281 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
9282 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
9283 @end deffn
9284
9285 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9286 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
9287 @end deffn
9288
9289 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
9290 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
9291 @end deffn
9292
9293 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9294 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
9295 @end deffn
9296
9297 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9298 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
9299 @end deffn
9300
9301 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
9302 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
9303 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
9304 and modifying how it is emptied.
9305 @end deffn
9306
9307 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
9308 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
9309 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
9310 The image @var{type} may be one of
9311 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
9312 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
9313 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
9314 @end deffn
9315
9316 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
9317 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
9318 @cindex vector_catch
9319 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
9320 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
9321
9322 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
9323 @example
9324 0x01 Trap Reset
9325 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
9326 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
9327 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
9328 0x10 Trap Data Abort
9329 0x20 reserved
9330 0x40 Trap IRQ
9331 0x80 Trap FIQ
9332 @end example
9333 @end deffn
9334
9335 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
9336 @cindex vector_table
9337
9338 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
9339 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
9340 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
9341 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
9342 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
9343
9344 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
9345
9346 @end deffn
9347
9348 @section ARMv6 Architecture
9349 @cindex ARMv6
9350
9351 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
9352 @cindex ARM11
9353
9354 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9355 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
9356 which is enabled by default.
9357 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9358 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
9359 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
9360 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
9361 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
9362 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9366 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
9367 which is enabled by default.
9368 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
9369 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
9370 @end deffn
9371
9372 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
9373 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
9374 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
9375 they are disabled by default.
9376 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
9377 @end deffn
9378
9379 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
9380 @cindex vector_catch
9381 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
9382 coprocessor 14 register 7.
9383 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
9384
9385 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9386 for certain hardware events.
9387 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
9388 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
9389 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
9390 @end deffn
9391
9392 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
9393 @cindex ARMv7
9394 @cindex ARMv8
9395
9396 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
9397 @cindex Cortex-A
9398
9399 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
9400 display information about target caches
9401 @end deffn
9402
9403 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
9404 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
9405 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
9406 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
9407 Defaults to 'off'.
9408 @end deffn
9409
9410 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
9411 Initialize core debug
9412 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9413 @end deffn
9414
9415 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp} [on|off]
9416 Display/set the current SMP mode
9417 @end deffn
9418
9419 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
9420 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
9421 @end deffn
9422
9423 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9424 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9425 @end deffn
9426
9427 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
9428 configure l2x cache
9429 @end deffn
9430
9431 @deffn Command {cortex_a mmu dump} [@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{addr} address [@option{num_entries}]]
9432 Dump the MMU translation table from TTB0 or TTB1 register, or from physical
9433 memory location @var{address}. When dumping the table from @var{address}, print at most
9434 @var{num_entries} page table entries. @var{num_entries} is optional, if omitted, the maximum
9435 possible (4096) entries are printed.
9436 @end deffn
9437
9438 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
9439 @cindex Cortex-R
9440
9441 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
9442 Initialize core debug
9443 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
9444 @end deffn
9445
9446 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9447 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
9448 @end deffn
9449
9450
9451 @subsection ARM CoreSight TPIU and SWO specific commands
9452 @cindex tracing
9453 @cindex SWO
9454 @cindex SWV
9455 @cindex TPIU
9456
9457 ARM CoreSight provides several modules to generate debugging
9458 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
9459 through TPIU or SWO modules to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
9460 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
9461
9462 ARM CoreSight provides independent HW blocks named TPIU and SWO each with its
9463 own functionality. Embedded in Cortex-M3 and M4, ARM provides an optional HW
9464 block that includes both TPIU and SWO functionalities and is again named TPIU,
9465 which causes quite some confusion.
9466 The registers map of all the TPIU and SWO implementations allows using a single
9467 driver that detects at runtime the features available.
9468
9469 The @command{tpiu} is used for either TPIU or SWO.
9470 A convenient alias @command{swo} is available to help distinguish, in scripts,
9471 the commands for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9472
9473 @deffn Command {swo} ...
9474 Alias of @command{tpiu ...}. Can be used in scripts to distinguish the commands
9475 for SWO from the commands for TPIU.
9476 @end deffn
9477
9478 @deffn Command {tpiu create} tpiu_name configparams...
9479 Creates a TPIU or a SWO object. The two commands are equivalent.
9480 Add the object in a list and add new commands (@command{@var{tpiu_name}})
9481 which are used for various purposes including additional configuration.
9482
9483 @itemize @bullet
9484 @item @var{tpiu_name} -- the name of the TPIU or SWO object.
9485 This name is also used to create the object's command, referred to here
9486 as @command{$tpiu_name}, and in other places where the TPIU or SWO needs to be identified.
9487 @item @var{configparams} -- all parameters accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} are permitted.
9488
9489 You @emph{must} set here the AP and MEM_AP base_address through @code{-dap @var{dap_name}},
9490 @code{-ap-num @var{ap_number}} and @code{-baseaddr @var{base_address}}.
9491 @end itemize
9492 @end deffn
9493
9494 @deffn Command {tpiu names}
9495 Lists all the TPIU or SWO objects created so far. The two commands are equivalent.
9496 @end deffn
9497
9498 @deffn Command {tpiu init}
9499 Initialize all registered TPIU and SWO. The two commands are equivalent.
9500 These commands are used internally during initialization. They can be issued
9501 at any time after the initialization, too.
9502 @end deffn
9503
9504 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name cget} queryparm
9505 Each configuration parameter accepted by @command{$tpiu_name configure} can be
9506 individually queried, to return its current value.
9507 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name accepted by that command, such as @code{-dap}.
9508 @end deffn
9509
9510 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name configure} configparams...
9511 The options accepted by this command may also be specified as parameters
9512 to @command{tpiu create}. Their values can later be queried one at a time by
9513 using the @command{$tpiu_name cget} command.
9514
9515 @itemize @bullet
9516 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access this
9517 TPIU. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to create and manage DAP instances.
9518
9519 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- sets DAP access port for TPIU,
9520 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the TPIU is connected to.
9521
9522 @item @code{-baseaddr} @var{base_address} -- sets the TPIU @var{base_address} where
9523 to access the TPIU in the DAP AP memory space.
9524
9525 @item @code{-protocol} (@option{sync}|@option{uart}|@option{manchester}) -- sets the
9526 protocol used for trace data:
9527 @itemize @minus
9528 @item @option{sync} -- synchronous parallel trace output mode, using @var{port_width}
9529 data bits (default);
9530 @item @option{uart} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as regular UART 8N1) coding;
9531 @item @option{manchester} -- use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester coding.
9532 @end itemize
9533
9534 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} -- assigns an event handler,
9535 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered. The events
9536 @code{pre-enable}, @code{post-enable}, @code{pre-disable} and @code{post-disable}
9537 are defined for TPIU/SWO.
9538 A typical use case for the event @code{pre-enable} is to enable the trace clock
9539 of the TPIU.
9540
9541 @item @code{-output} (@option{external}|@option{:}@var{port}|@var{filename}|@option{-}) -- specifies
9542 the destination of the trace data:
9543 @itemize @minus
9544 @item @option{external} -- configure TPIU/SWO to let user capture trace
9545 output externally, either with an additional UART or with a logic analyzer (default);
9546 @item @option{-} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather trace data
9547 and forward it to @command{tcl_trace} command;
9548 @item @option{:}@var{port} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to gather
9549 trace data, open a TCP server at port @var{port} and send the trace data to
9550 each connected client;
9551 @item @var{filename} -- configure TPIU/SWO and debug adapter to
9552 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename}, which can be
9553 either a regular file or a named pipe.
9554 @end itemize
9555
9556 @item @code{-traceclk} @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} -- mandatory parameter.
9557 Specifies the frequency in Hz of the trace clock. For the TPIU embedded in
9558 Cortex-M3 or M4, this is usually the same frequency as HCLK. For protocol
9559 @option{sync} this is twice the frequency of the pin data rate.
9560
9561 @item @code{-pin-freq} @var{trace_freq} -- specifies the expected data rate
9562 in Hz of the SWO pin. Parameter used only on protocols @option{uart} and
9563 @option{manchester}. Can be omitted to let the adapter driver select the
9564 maximum supported rate automatically.
9565
9566 @item @code{-port-width} @var{port_width} -- sets to @var{port_width} the width
9567 of the synchronous parallel port used for trace output. Parameter used only on
9568 protocol @option{sync}. If not specified, default value is @var{1}.
9569
9570 @item @code{-formatter} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- specifies if the formatter
9571 should be enabled. Parameter used only on protocol @option{sync}. If not specified,
9572 default value is @var{0}.
9573 @end itemize
9574 @end deffn
9575
9576 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name enable}
9577 Uses the parameters specified by the previous @command{$tpiu_name configure}
9578 to configure and enable the TPIU or the SWO.
9579 If required, the adapter is also configured and enabled to receive the trace
9580 data.
9581 This command can be used before @command{init}, but it will take effect only
9582 after the @command{init}.
9583 @end deffn
9584
9585 @deffn Command {$tpiu_name disable}
9586 Disable the TPIU or the SWO, terminating the receiving of the trace data.
9587 @end deffn
9588
9589
9590
9591 Example usage:
9592 @enumerate
9593 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
9594 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
9595 enough to:
9596 @example
9597 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
9598 ...
9599 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
9600 ...
9601 @end example
9602 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
9603 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
9604 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
9605 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
9606 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
9607 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
9608 @example
9609 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
9610 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
9611 @end example
9612 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
9613 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
9614 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
9615 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
9616 @example
9617 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
9618 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
9619 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
9620 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -protocol uart" \
9621 -c "stm32l1.tpiu configure -traceclk 24000000 -pin-freq 12000000" \
9622 -c "stm32l1.tpiu enable"
9623 @end example
9624 @end enumerate
9625
9626 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
9627 @cindex tracing
9628 @cindex SWO
9629 @cindex SWV
9630 @cindex ITM
9631 @cindex ETM
9632
9633 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9634 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
9635 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
9636 @end deffn
9637
9638 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
9639 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
9640 @end deffn
9641
9642 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
9643 @cindex Cortex-M
9644
9645 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off}|@option{steponly})
9646 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
9647
9648 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
9649 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
9650 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
9651 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
9652 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
9653 the step command leaves with the core running.
9654
9655 The @option{steponly} option disables interrupts during single-stepping but
9656 enables them during normal execution. This can be used as a partial workaround
9657 for 702596 erratum in Cortex-M7 r0p1. See "Cortex-M7 (AT610) and Cortex-M7 with
9658 FPU (AT611) Software Developer Errata Notice" from ARM for further details.
9659
9660 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
9661 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
9662 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
9663 does.
9664
9665 Default is @option{auto}.
9666 @end deffn
9667
9668 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
9669 @cindex vector_catch
9670 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
9671 for certain hardware events.
9672
9673 Parameters request interception of
9674 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
9675 @option{none} of them,
9676 or one or more of the following:
9677 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
9678 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
9679 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
9680 @option{irq_err},
9681 @option{state_err},
9682 @option{chk_err}, or
9683 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
9684 @option{reset}.
9685 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
9686 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
9687 are mapped to HardFault.
9688 UsageFault checks for
9689 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
9690 must also be explicitly enabled.
9691
9692 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
9693 @end deffn
9694
9695 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
9696 Control reset handling if hardware srst is not fitted
9697 @xref{reset_config,,reset_config}.
9698
9699 @itemize @minus
9700 @item @option{sysresetreq} use AIRCR SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
9701 @item @option{vectreset} use AIRCR VECTRESET to reset system (default).
9702 @end itemize
9703
9704 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for Cortex-M3, M4 and M7 cores.
9705 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
9706 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler
9707 to manually reset the peripherals.
9708 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9709
9710 Cortex-M0, M0+ and M1 do not support @option{vectreset}, use @option{sysresetreq}
9711 instead.
9712 @end deffn
9713
9714 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
9715 @cindex ARMv8-A
9716 @cindex aarch64
9717
9718 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
9719 Display information about target caches
9720 @end deffn
9721
9722 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
9723 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
9724 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
9725 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
9726 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
9727 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
9728 @end deffn
9729
9730 @deffn Command {aarch64 disassemble} address [count]
9731 @cindex disassemble
9732 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
9733 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
9734 @end deffn
9735
9736 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp} [on|off]
9737 Display, enable or disable SMP handling mode. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
9738 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
9739 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
9740 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
9741 @end deffn
9742
9743 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
9744 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
9745 @option{on}.
9746 @end deffn
9747
9748 @deffn Command {$target_name catch_exc} [@option{off}|@option{sec_el1}|@option{sec_el3}|@option{nsec_el1}|@option{nsec_el2}]+
9749 Cause @command{$target_name} to halt when an exception is taken. Any combination of
9750 Secure (sec) EL1/EL3 or Non-Secure (nsec) EL1/EL2 is valid. The target
9751 @command{$target_name} will halt before taking the exception. In order to resume
9752 the target, the exception catch must be disabled again with @command{$target_name catch_exc off}.
9753 Issuing the command without options prints the current configuration.
9754 @end deffn
9755
9756 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
9757
9758 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
9759 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
9760
9761 @subsection eSi-RISC Configuration
9762
9763 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
9764 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
9765 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
9766 @end deffn
9767
9768 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
9769 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
9770 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
9771 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
9772 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
9773 @end deffn
9774
9775 @subsection eSi-RISC Operation
9776
9777 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
9778 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
9779 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
9780 @end deffn
9781
9782 @subsection eSi-Trace Configuration
9783
9784 eSi-RISC targets may be configured with support for instruction tracing. Trace
9785 data may be written to an in-memory buffer or FIFO. If a FIFO is configured, DMA
9786 is typically employed to move trace data off-device using a high-speed
9787 peripheral (eg. SPI). Collected trace data is encoded in one of three different
9788 formats. At a minimum, @command{esirisc trace buffer} or @command{esirisc trace
9789 fifo} must be issued along with @command{esirisc trace format} before trace data
9790 can be collected.
9791
9792 OpenOCD provides rudimentary analysis of collected trace data. If more detail is
9793 needed, collected trace data can be dumped to a file and processed by external
9794 tooling.
9795
9796 @quotation Issues
9797 OpenOCD is unable to process trace data sent to a FIFO. A potential workaround
9798 for this issue is to configure DMA to copy trace data to an in-memory buffer,
9799 which can then be passed to the @command{esirisc trace analyze} and
9800 @command{esirisc trace dump} commands.
9801
9802 It is possible to corrupt trace data when using a FIFO if the peripheral
9803 responsible for draining data from the FIFO is not fast enough. This can be
9804 managed by enabling flow control, however this can impact timing-sensitive
9805 software operation on the CPU.
9806 @end quotation
9807
9808 @deffn Command {esirisc trace buffer} address size [@option{wrap}]
9809 Configure trace buffer using the provided address and size. If the @option{wrap}
9810 option is specified, trace collection will continue once the end of the buffer
9811 is reached. By default, wrap is disabled.
9812 @end deffn
9813
9814 @deffn Command {esirisc trace fifo} address
9815 Configure trace FIFO using the provided address.
9816 @end deffn
9817
9818 @deffn Command {esirisc trace flow_control} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9819 Enable or disable stalling the CPU to collect trace data. By default, flow
9820 control is disabled.
9821 @end deffn
9822
9823 @deffn Command {esirisc trace format} (@option{full}|@option{branch}|@option{icache}) pc_bits
9824 Configure trace format and number of PC bits to be captured. @option{pc_bits}
9825 must be within 1 and 31 as the LSB is not collected. If external tooling is used
9826 to analyze collected trace data, these values must match.
9827
9828 Supported trace formats:
9829 @itemize
9830 @item @option{full} capture full trace data, allowing execution history and
9831 timing to be determined.
9832 @item @option{branch} capture taken branch instructions and branch target
9833 addresses.
9834 @item @option{icache} capture instruction cache misses.
9835 @end itemize
9836 @end deffn
9837
9838 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger start} (@option{condition}) [start_data start_mask]
9839 Configure trigger start condition using the provided start data and mask. A
9840 brief description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how
9841 these values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9842
9843 Supported conditions:
9844 @itemize
9845 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace start}).
9846 @item @option{pc} start tracing if the PC matches start data and mask.
9847 @item @option{load} start tracing if the effective address of a load
9848 instruction matches start data and mask.
9849 @item @option{store} start tracing if the effective address of a store
9850 instruction matches start data and mask.
9851 @item @option{exception} start tracing if the EID of an exception matches start
9852 data and mask.
9853 @item @option{eret} start tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9854 @item @option{wait} start tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9855 @item @option{stop} start tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9856 @item @option{high} start tracing when an external signal is a logical high.
9857 @item @option{low} start tracing when an external signal is a logical low.
9858 @end itemize
9859 @end deffn
9860
9861 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger stop} (@option{condition}) [stop_data stop_mask]
9862 Configure trigger stop condition using the provided stop data and mask. A brief
9863 description of each condition is provided below; for more detail on how these
9864 values are used, see the eSi-RISC Architecture Manual.
9865
9866 Supported conditions:
9867 @itemize
9868 @item @option{none} manual tracing (see @command{esirisc trace stop}).
9869 @item @option{pc} stop tracing if the PC matches stop data and mask.
9870 @item @option{load} stop tracing if the effective address of a load
9871 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9872 @item @option{store} stop tracing if the effective address of a store
9873 instruction matches stop data and mask.
9874 @item @option{exception} stop tracing if the EID of an exception matches stop
9875 data and mask.
9876 @item @option{eret} stop tracing when an @code{ERET} instruction is executed.
9877 @item @option{wait} stop tracing when a @code{WAIT} instruction is executed.
9878 @item @option{stop} stop tracing when a @code{STOP} instruction is executed.
9879 @end itemize
9880 @end deffn
9881
9882 @deffn Command {esirisc trace trigger delay} (@option{trigger}) [cycles]
9883 Configure trigger start/stop delay in clock cycles.
9884
9885 Supported triggers:
9886 @itemize
9887 @item @option{none} no delay to start or stop collection.
9888 @item @option{start} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to start collection.
9889 @item @option{stop} delay @option{cycles} after trigger to stop collection.
9890 @item @option{both} delay @option{cycles} after both triggers to start or stop
9891 collection.
9892 @end itemize
9893 @end deffn
9894
9895 @subsection eSi-Trace Operation
9896
9897 @deffn Command {esirisc trace init}
9898 Initialize trace collection. This command must be called any time the
9899 configuration changes. If a trace buffer has been configured, the contents will
9900 be overwritten when trace collection starts.
9901 @end deffn
9902
9903 @deffn Command {esirisc trace info}
9904 Display trace configuration.
9905 @end deffn
9906
9907 @deffn Command {esirisc trace status}
9908 Display trace collection status.
9909 @end deffn
9910
9911 @deffn Command {esirisc trace start}
9912 Start manual trace collection.
9913 @end deffn
9914
9915 @deffn Command {esirisc trace stop}
9916 Stop manual trace collection.
9917 @end deffn
9918
9919 @deffn Command {esirisc trace analyze} [address size]
9920 Analyze collected trace data. This command may only be used if a trace buffer
9921 has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must be
9922 copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9923 @option{size} options using DMA.
9924 @end deffn
9925
9926 @deffn Command {esirisc trace dump} [address size] @file{filename}
9927 Dump collected trace data to file. This command may only be used if a trace
9928 buffer has been configured. If a trace FIFO has been configured, trace data must
9929 be copied to an in-memory buffer identified by the @option{address} and
9930 @option{size} options using DMA.
9931 @end deffn
9932
9933 @section Intel Architecture
9934
9935 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
9936 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
9937 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
9938 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
9939 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
9940 @itemize
9941 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
9942 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
9943 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
9944 @end itemize
9945
9946 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
9947 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
9948 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
9949
9950 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9951 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9952 @end deffn
9953
9954 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9955 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9956 @end deffn
9957
9958 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9959 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9960 @end deffn
9961
9962 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9963 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9964 @end deffn
9965
9966 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9967 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9968 @end deffn
9969
9970 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9971 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9972 @end deffn
9973
9974 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9975
9976 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9977 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9978
9979 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9980 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9981 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9982 @end deffn
9983 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9984 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9985
9986 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9987
9988 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9989 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9990 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9991 @end deffn
9992
9993 @subsection Registers commands
9994 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9995 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9996 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9997
9998 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9999
10000 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
10001 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
10002 and "timer" groups.
10003
10004 @emph{example:}
10005 @example
10006 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
10007 @end example
10008
10009
10010 @end deffn
10011 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
10012 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
10013
10014 @emph{group} can be "system",
10015 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
10016 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
10017 @end deffn
10018
10019 @section RISC-V Architecture
10020
10021 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
10022 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
10023 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
10024 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
10025 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
10026 implement version 0.11.
10027
10028 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
10029
10030 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
10031 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
10032 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
10033
10034 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
10035
10036 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10037 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
10038 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
10039
10040 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
10041 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
10042 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
10043 CSRs.
10044 @end deffn
10045
10046 @deffn Command {riscv expose_custom} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
10047 The RISC-V Debug Specification allows targets to expose custom registers
10048 through abstract commands. (See Section 3.5.1.1 in that document.) This command
10049 configures a list of inclusive ranges of those registers to expose. Number 0
10050 indicates the first custom register, whose abstract command number is 0xc000.
10051 This command must be executed before `init`.
10052 @end deffn
10053
10054 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10055 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
10056 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
10057 @end deffn
10058
10059 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
10060 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
10061 deasserted.
10062 @end deffn
10063
10064 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
10065 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
10066 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
10067 @end deffn
10068
10069 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
10070 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off (default),
10071 prefer to use the Program Buffer to access memory.
10072 @end deffn
10073
10074 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virtual} on|off
10075 When on, memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory depending
10076 on the current system configuration. When off (default), all memory accessses are performed
10077 on physical memory.
10078 @end deffn
10079
10080 @deffn Command {riscv set_enable_virt2phys} on|off
10081 When on (default), memory accesses are performed on physical or virtual memory
10082 depending on the current satp configuration. When off, all memory accessses are
10083 performed on physical memory.
10084 @end deffn
10085
10086 @deffn Command {riscv resume_order} normal|reversed
10087 Some software assumes all harts are executing nearly continuously. Such
10088 software may be sensitive to the order that harts are resumed in. On harts
10089 that don't support hasel, this option allows the user to choose the order the
10090 harts are resumed in. If you are using this option, it's probably masking a
10091 race condition problem in your code.
10092
10093 Normal order is from lowest hart index to highest. This is the default
10094 behavior. Reversed order is from highest hart index to lowest.
10095 @end deffn
10096
10097 @deffn Command {riscv set_ir} (@option{idcode}|@option{dtmcs}|@option{dmi}) [value]
10098 Set the IR value for the specified JTAG register. This is useful, for
10099 example, when using the existing JTAG interface on a Xilinx FPGA by
10100 way of BSCANE2 primitives that only permit a limited selection of IR
10101 values.
10102
10103 When utilizing version 0.11 of the RISC-V Debug Specification,
10104 @option{dtmcs} and @option{dmi} set the IR values for the DTMCONTROL
10105 and DBUS registers, respectively.
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @deffn Command {riscv use_bscan_tunnel} value
10109 Enable or disable use of a BSCAN tunnel to reach DM. Supply the width of
10110 the DM transport TAP's instruction register to enable. Supply a value of 0 to disable.
10111 @end deffn
10112
10113 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreakm} on|off
10114 Control dcsr.ebreakm. When on (default), M-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10115 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10116 @end deffn
10117
10118 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaks} on|off
10119 Control dcsr.ebreaks. When on (default), S-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10120 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10121 @end deffn
10122
10123 @deffn Command {riscv set_ebreaku} on|off
10124 Control dcsr.ebreaku. When on (default), U-mode ebreak instructions trap to
10125 OpenOCD. When off, they generate a breakpoint exception handled internally.
10126 @end deffn
10127
10128 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
10129
10130 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
10131 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
10132 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
10133 @example
10134 set challenge [riscv authdata_read]
10135 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
10136 @end example
10137
10138 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
10139 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata.
10140 @end deffn
10141
10142 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
10143 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
10144 @end deffn
10145
10146 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
10147
10148 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
10149 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
10150
10151 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read} address
10152 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value.
10153 @end deffn
10154
10155 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
10156 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
10157 @end deffn
10158
10159 @section ARC Architecture
10160 @cindex ARC
10161
10162 Synopsys DesignWare ARC Processors are a family of 32-bit CPUs that SoC
10163 designers can optimize for a wide range of uses, from deeply embedded to
10164 high-performance host applications in a variety of market segments. See more
10165 at: @url{http://www.synopsys.com/IP/ProcessorIP/ARCProcessors/Pages/default.aspx}.
10166 OpenOCD currently supports ARC EM processors.
10167 There is a set ARC-specific OpenOCD commands that allow low-level
10168 access to the core and provide necessary support for ARC extensibility and
10169 configurability capabilities. ARC processors has much more configuration
10170 capabilities than most of the other processors and in addition there is an
10171 extension interface that allows SoC designers to add custom registers and
10172 instructions. For the OpenOCD that mostly means that set of core and AUX
10173 registers in target will vary and is not fixed for a particular processor
10174 model. To enable extensibility several TCL commands are provided that allow to
10175 describe those optional registers in OpenOCD configuration files. Moreover
10176 those commands allow for a dynamic target features discovery.
10177
10178
10179 @subsection General ARC commands
10180
10181 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg} configparams
10182
10183 Add a new register to processor target. By default newly created register is
10184 marked as not existing. @var{configparams} must have following required
10185 arguments:
10186
10187 @itemize @bullet
10188
10189 @item @code{-name} name
10190 @*Name of a register.
10191
10192 @item @code{-num} number
10193 @*Architectural register number: core register number or AUX register number.
10194
10195 @item @code{-feature} XML_feature
10196 @*Name of GDB XML target description feature.
10197
10198 @end itemize
10199
10200 @var{configparams} may have following optional arguments:
10201
10202 @itemize @bullet
10203
10204 @item @code{-gdbnum} number
10205 @*GDB register number. It is recommended to not assign GDB register number
10206 manually, because there would be a risk that two register will have same
10207 number. When register GDB number is not set with this option, then register
10208 will get a previous register number + 1. This option is required only for those
10209 registers that must be at particular address expected by GDB.
10210
10211 @item @code{-core}
10212 @*This option specifies that register is a core registers. If not - this is an
10213 AUX register. AUX registers and core registers reside in different address
10214 spaces.
10215
10216 @item @code{-bcr}
10217 @*This options specifies that register is a BCR register. BCR means Build
10218 Configuration Registers - this is a special type of AUX registers that are read
10219 only and non-volatile, that is - they never change their value. Therefore OpenOCD
10220 never invalidates values of those registers in internal caches. Because BCR is a
10221 type of AUX registers, this option cannot be used with @code{-core}.
10222
10223 @item @code{-type} type_name
10224 @*Name of type of this register. This can be either one of the basic GDB types,
10225 or a custom types described with @command{arc add-reg-type-[flags|struct]}.
10226
10227 @item @code{-g}
10228 @* If specified then this is a "general" register. General registers are always
10229 read by OpenOCD on context save (when core has just been halted) and is always
10230 transferred to GDB client in a response to g-packet. Contrary to this,
10231 non-general registers are read and sent to GDB client on-demand. In general it
10232 is not recommended to apply this option to custom registers.
10233
10234 @end itemize
10235
10236 @end deffn
10237
10238 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-flags} -name name flags...
10239 Adds new register type of ``flags'' class. ``Flags'' types can contain only
10240 one-bit fields. Each flag definition looks like @code{-flag name bit-position}.
10241 @end deffn
10242
10243 @anchor{add-reg-type-struct}
10244 @deffn {Config Command} {arc add-reg-type-struct} -name name structs...
10245 Adds new register type of ``struct'' class. ``Struct'' types can contain either
10246 bit-fields or fields of other types, however at the moment only bit fields are
10247 supported. Structure bit field definition looks like @code{-bitfield name
10248 startbit endbit}.
10249 @end deffn
10250
10251 @deffn {Command} {arc get-reg-field} reg-name field-name
10252 Returns value of bit-field in a register. Register must be ``struct'' register
10253 type, @xref{add-reg-type-struct} command definition.
10254 @end deffn
10255
10256 @deffn {Command} {arc set-reg-exists} reg-names...
10257 Specify that some register exists. Any amount of names can be passed
10258 as an argument for a single command invocation.
10259 @end deffn
10260
10261 @subsection ARC JTAG commands
10262
10263 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-aux-reg} regnum value
10264 This command writes value to AUX register via its number. This command access
10265 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10266 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10267
10268 @end deffn
10269
10270 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag set-core-reg} regnum value
10271 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag set-aux-reg} but is for core
10272 registers.
10273 @end deffn
10274
10275 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-aux-reg} regnum
10276 This command returns the value storded in AUX register via its number. This commands access
10277 register in target directly via JTAG, bypassing any OpenOCD internal caches,
10278 therefore it is unsafe to use if that register can be operated by other means.
10279
10280 @end deffn
10281
10282 @deffn {Command} {arc jtag get-core-reg} regnum
10283 This command is similar to @command{arc jtag get-aux-reg} but is for core
10284 registers.
10285 @end deffn
10286
10287 @section STM8 Architecture
10288 @uref{http://st.com/stm8/, STM8} is a 8-bit microcontroller platform from
10289 STMicroelectronics, based on a proprietary 8-bit core architecture.
10290
10291 OpenOCD supports debugging STM8 through the STMicroelectronics debug
10292 protocol SWIM, @pxref{swimtransport,,SWIM}.
10293
10294 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
10295 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
10296 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
10297 @cindex tracing
10298 @cindex libdcc
10299 @cindex DCC
10300 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
10301 the target uses appropriate libraries.
10302 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
10303 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
10304
10305 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
10306 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
10307 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
10308 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
10309 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
10310 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
10311
10312 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
10313 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
10314 arrays of various size integers from the target,
10315 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
10316 The target being debugged may
10317 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
10318 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
10319 each supported by a command:
10320
10321 @itemize
10322 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
10323 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
10324 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
10325 finding out how some fault was triggered.
10326
10327 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
10328 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
10329 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
10330
10331 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
10332 and then displayed at any time.
10333 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
10334
10335 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
10336 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
10337 @end itemize
10338
10339 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
10340 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
10341 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
10342 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
10343 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
10344 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
10345 does the same thing.
10346
10347 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
10348 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
10349 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
10350 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
10351 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
10352
10353 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
10354 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
10355 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
10356 @end deffn
10357
10358 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
10359 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
10360 in the order they triggered.
10361 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
10362 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
10363 history records.
10364 @end deffn
10365
10366 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
10367 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
10368 they have been triggered.
10369 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
10370 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
10371 and associates it with that identifier.
10372
10373 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
10374 are not related except by this command.
10375 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
10376 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
10377 @end deffn
10378
10379
10380 @node JTAG Commands
10381 @chapter JTAG Commands
10382 @cindex JTAG Commands
10383 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
10384 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
10385 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
10386 may be needed to work with targets which require special
10387 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
10388
10389 To use these commands you will need to understand some
10390 of the basics of JTAG, including:
10391
10392 @itemize @bullet
10393 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
10394 devices such as a CPUs.
10395 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
10396 standard state machine (in parallel)
10397 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
10398 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
10399 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
10400 while the reading previous ones.
10401 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
10402 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
10403 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
10404 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
10405 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
10406 registers.
10407 @end itemize
10408
10409 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
10410
10411 These commands are used by developers who need to access
10412 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
10413 the order of TAP state transitions.
10414 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
10415 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
10416 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
10417 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
10418 these commands are not available.
10419
10420 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10421 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
10422 that specify the entire register.
10423 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
10424 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
10425 The return value holds the original value of each
10426 of those fields.
10427
10428 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
10429 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
10430 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
10431 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
10432 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
10433
10434 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
10435 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
10436
10437 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10438 in that state.
10439 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
10440 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10441 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10442
10443 @quotation Warning
10444 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
10445 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
10446 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
10447 data registers, which may have different lengths.
10448 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
10449 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
10450 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
10451 (by connecting a different scan chain).
10452 @end quotation
10453 @end deffn
10454
10455 @deffn Command {flush_count}
10456 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
10457 This may be used for performance tuning.
10458
10459 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
10460 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
10461 not change with the amount of data which is written.
10462 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
10463 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
10464 instead of batching them into larger operations.
10465 @end deffn
10466
10467 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
10468 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
10469 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
10470 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
10471 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
10472 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
10473
10474 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
10475 in that state.
10476 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
10477 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
10478 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
10479
10480 @quotation Note
10481 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
10482 register values, unlike data register values.
10483 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
10484 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
10485 @end quotation
10486 @end deffn
10487
10488 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
10489 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
10490 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
10491 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
10492 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
10493 Then, in a series of single state transitions
10494 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
10495 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
10496 The final state must also be stable.
10497 @end deffn
10498
10499 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
10500 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
10501 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
10502 Instructions often need some time
10503 to execute before they take effect.
10504 @end deffn
10505
10506 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
10507 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
10508
10509 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10510 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
10511 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
10512 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
10513 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
10514 @end deffn
10515
10516 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
10517 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
10518 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
10519 must also be enabled.
10520 Default is enabled.
10521 @end deffn
10522
10523 @section TAP state names
10524 @cindex TAP state names
10525
10526 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
10527 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
10528 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
10529 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
10530
10531 @itemize @bullet
10532 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
10533 acts as if TRST were pulsed
10534 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
10535 @item @b{DRSELECT}
10536 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
10537 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10538 through the data register
10539 @item @b{DREXIT1}
10540 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
10541 for update or more shifting
10542 @item @b{DREXIT2}
10543 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
10544 @item @b{IRSELECT}
10545 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
10546 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
10547 through the instruction register
10548 @item @b{IREXIT1}
10549 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
10550 for update or more shifting
10551 @item @b{IREXIT2}
10552 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
10553 @end itemize
10554
10555 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
10556 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
10557 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
10558 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
10559
10560 @itemize @bullet
10561 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
10562 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
10563 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
10564 may not be as expected.
10565 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
10566 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
10567 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
10568 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
10569 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
10570 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
10571 @end itemize
10572
10573 @node Boundary Scan Commands
10574 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
10575
10576 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
10577 boundary scan based hardware testing.
10578 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
10579 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
10580
10581 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
10582 @cindex Serial Vector Format
10583 @cindex SVF
10584
10585 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
10586 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
10587 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10588 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10589
10590 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
10591 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
10592 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10593 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
10594
10595 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
10596 affect their semantics.
10597
10598 Command options:
10599 @itemize @minus
10600 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
10601 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
10602 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
10603 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
10604 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
10605 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
10606 on the real interface;
10607 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
10608 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
10609 errors.
10610 @end itemize
10611 @end deffn
10612
10613 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10614 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
10615 @cindex XSVF
10616
10617 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
10618 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
10619 Xilinx devices.
10620 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
10621 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
10622
10623 @quotation Important
10624 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
10625 @end quotation
10626
10627 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
10628 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
10629 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
10630 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
10631 that TAP.
10632 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
10633 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
10634 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
10635 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
10636 @end deffn
10637
10638 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
10639 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
10640 after building the software.
10641 You may find them useful:
10642
10643 @itemize
10644 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
10645 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
10646 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
10647 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
10648 @end itemize
10649
10650 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
10651 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
10652 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
10653 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
10654 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
10655 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
10656 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
10657
10658
10659 @node Utility Commands
10660 @chapter Utility Commands
10661 @cindex Utility Commands
10662
10663 @section RAM testing
10664 @cindex RAM testing
10665
10666 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
10667 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
10668 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
10669 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
10670 hardware problems.
10671
10672 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
10673 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
10674 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
10675 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
10676
10677 Load the memory testing functions with
10678
10679 @example
10680 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
10681 @end example
10682
10683 to get access to the following facilities:
10684
10685 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
10686 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
10687 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
10688 @end deffn
10689
10690 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
10691 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
10692 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
10693 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
10694 @end deffn
10695
10696 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
10697 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
10698 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
10699 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
10700 @end deffn
10701
10702 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
10703 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
10704 @end deffn
10705
10706 @section Firmware recovery helpers
10707 @cindex Firmware recovery
10708
10709 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
10710 devices recovery with JTAG.
10711
10712 For quickstart instructions run:
10713 @example
10714 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
10715 @end example
10716
10717 @node GDB and OpenOCD
10718 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
10719 @cindex GDB
10720 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
10721 to debug remote targets.
10722 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
10723
10724 @itemize
10725 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
10726 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
10727 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
10728 as shown in this chapter.
10729 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
10730 that also will probably need to be configured.
10731 @end itemize
10732
10733 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
10734 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
10735 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
10736 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
10737 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
10738 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
10739
10740 @section Connecting to GDB
10741 @cindex Connecting to GDB
10742 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
10743 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
10744 errors, which has since been fixed; see
10745 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
10746
10747 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
10748
10749 @enumerate
10750 @item
10751 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
10752 @example
10753 target extended-remote localhost:3333
10754 @end example
10755 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
10756
10757 The extended remote protocol is a super-set of the remote protocol and should
10758 be the preferred choice. More details are available in GDB documentation
10759 @url{https://sourceware.org/gdb/onlinedocs/gdb/Connecting.html}
10760
10761 To speed-up typing, any GDB command can be abbreviated, including the extended
10762 remote command above that becomes:
10763 @example
10764 tar ext :3333
10765 @end example
10766
10767 @b{Note:} If any backward compatibility issue requires using the old remote
10768 protocol in place of the extended remote one, the former protocol is still
10769 available through the command:
10770 @example
10771 target remote localhost:3333
10772 @end example
10773
10774 @item
10775 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
10776 @example
10777 target extended-remote | \
10778 openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
10779 @end example
10780 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
10781 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
10782 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
10783 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
10784 @end enumerate
10785
10786 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
10787 GDB command line.
10788
10789 @section Sample GDB session startup
10790
10791 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
10792 than they do when you're debugging locally.
10793 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
10794 small ARM program.
10795 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
10796 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
10797
10798 @example
10799 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
10800 (gdb) target extended-remote localhost:3333
10801 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
10802 ...
10803 (gdb) monitor reset halt
10804 ...
10805 (gdb) load
10806 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
10807 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
10808 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
10809 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
10810 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
10811 (gdb) continue
10812 Continuing.
10813 ...
10814 @end example
10815
10816 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
10817 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
10818 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
10819 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
10820
10821 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
10822
10823 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
10824 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
10825 packet size and the device's memory map.
10826 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
10827 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
10828 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
10829
10830 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
10831 You may need to set those up by hand.
10832 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
10833 something like:
10834
10835 @example
10836 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
10837 @end example
10838
10839 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
10840
10841 @example
10842 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
10843 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
10844 @end example
10845
10846 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
10847 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
10848 do not have such restrictions.
10849
10850 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
10851 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
10852 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
10853 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
10854
10855 @section Programming using GDB
10856 @cindex Programming using GDB
10857 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
10858
10859 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
10860 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
10861 @example
10862 gdb_memory_map disable
10863 @end example
10864 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
10865 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
10866 working area.
10867
10868 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
10869 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
10870 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
10871 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
10872
10873 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
10874 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
10875
10876 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
10877 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
10878 @example
10879 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
10880 @end example
10881
10882 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
10883 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
10884
10885 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
10886 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
10887 will be used.
10888
10889 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
10890 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
10891 @example
10892 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
10893 @end example
10894 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
10895
10896 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
10897 can be used.
10898
10899 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10900 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
10901 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
10902
10903 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
10904 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
10905 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
10906
10907 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
10908 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
10909 and GDB treats it as it were running.
10910 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
10911 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
10912 without any intrusion of the target process.
10913
10914 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
10915 Place following command after target configuration:
10916 @example
10917 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
10918 @end example
10919
10920 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
10921 switch off gdb_memory_map:
10922 @example
10923 gdb_memory_map disable
10924 @end example
10925
10926 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
10927 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
10928 @example
10929 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
10930 @end example
10931
10932 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
10933 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
10934
10935 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target extended-remote ...} and inspect memory
10936 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
10937 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
10938 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
10939
10940 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
10941 previously shown variables.
10942
10943 It's also possible to connect more than one GDB to the same target by the
10944 target's configuration option @code{-gdb-max-connections}. This allows, for
10945 example, one GDB to run a script that continuously polls a set of variables
10946 while other GDB can be used interactively. Be extremely careful in this case,
10947 because the two GDB can easily get out-of-sync.
10948
10949 @section RTOS Support
10950 @cindex RTOS Support
10951 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
10952
10953 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
10954 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
10955
10956 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
10957 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
10958 GDB commands.
10959
10960 @* An example setup is below:
10961
10962 @example
10963 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
10964 @end example
10965
10966 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
10967
10968 Currently supported rtos's include:
10969 @itemize @bullet
10970 @item @option{eCos}
10971 @item @option{ThreadX}
10972 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
10973 @item @option{linux}
10974 @item @option{ChibiOS}
10975 @item @option{embKernel}
10976 @item @option{mqx}
10977 @item @option{uCOS-III}
10978 @item @option{nuttx}
10979 @item @option{RIOT}
10980 @item @option{hwthread} (This is not an actual RTOS. @xref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.)
10981 @end itemize
10982
10983 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
10984 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
10985
10986 @table @code
10987 @item eCos symbols
10988 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
10989 @item ThreadX symbols
10990 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
10991 @item FreeRTOS symbols
10992 @raggedright
10993 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
10994 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
10995 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
10996 @end raggedright
10997 @item linux symbols
10998 init_task.
10999 @item ChibiOS symbols
11000 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
11001 @item embKernel symbols
11002 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
11003 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
11004 @item mqx symbols
11005 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
11006 @item uC/OS-III symbols
11007 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty.
11008 @item nuttx symbols
11009 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable.
11010 @item RIOT symbols
11011 @raggedright
11012 sched_threads, sched_num_threads, sched_active_pid, max_threads,
11013 _tcb_name_offset.
11014 @end raggedright
11015 @end table
11016
11017 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
11018 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
11019
11020 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
11021 along with the project:
11022
11023 @table @code
11024 @item FreeRTOS
11025 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
11026 @item uC/OS-III
11027 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
11028 @end table
11029
11030 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
11031 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
11032 @cindex SMP
11033 @cindex RTOS
11034 @cindex hwthread
11035 OpenOCD includes a pseudo RTOS called @emph{hwthread} that presents CPU cores
11036 ("hardware threads") in an SMP system as threads to GDB. With this extension,
11037 GDB can be used to inspect the state of an SMP system in a natural way.
11038 After halting the system, using the GDB command @command{info threads} will
11039 list the context of each active CPU core in the system. GDB's @command{thread}
11040 command can be used to switch the view to a different CPU core.
11041 The @command{step} and @command{stepi} commands can be used to step a specific core
11042 while other cores are free-running or remain halted, depending on the
11043 scheduler-locking mode configured in GDB.
11044
11045 @section Legacy SMP core switching support
11046 @quotation Note
11047 This method is deprecated in favor of the @emph{hwthread} pseudo RTOS.
11048 @end quotation
11049
11050 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
11051 @itemize @bullet
11052 @item j - smp status request
11053 @item J - smp set request
11054 @end itemize
11055
11056 OpenOCD implements :
11057 @itemize @bullet
11058 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
11059 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
11060 @option{E01} for target not smp.
11061 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
11062 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
11063 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
11064 @end itemize
11065
11066 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
11067 @itemize @bullet
11068 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
11069 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
11070 @example
11071 set $_core 1
11072 #Jc01 packet is sent
11073 print $_core
11074 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
11075 @end example
11076
11077 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
11078 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
11079
11080 @example
11081 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
11082 define toggle0
11083 maint packet Jc0
11084 continue
11085 main packet Jc-1
11086 end
11087 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
11088 define toggle1
11089 maint packet Jc1
11090 continue
11091 main packet Jc-1
11092 end
11093 @end example
11094 @end itemize
11095
11096 @node Tcl Scripting API
11097 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
11098 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
11099 @cindex Tcl scripts
11100 @section API rules
11101
11102 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
11103 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
11104 of state information as an argument to each proc.
11105
11106 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
11107 pair list and lists.
11108
11109 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
11110 list.
11111
11112 @example
11113 > set foo(me) Duane
11114 > set foo(you) Oyvind
11115 > set foo(mouse) Micky
11116 > set foo(duck) Donald
11117 @end example
11118
11119 If one does this:
11120
11121 @example
11122 > set foo
11123 @end example
11124
11125 The result is:
11126
11127 @example
11128 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
11129 @end example
11130
11131 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
11132
11133 @verbatim
11134 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
11135 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
11136 }
11137 @end verbatim
11138
11139 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
11140 should be passed in to the proc in question.
11141
11142 @section Internal low-level Commands
11143
11144 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
11145 invoke directly.
11146
11147 @itemize @bullet
11148 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11149
11150 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
11151 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
11152
11153 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
11154 @item @b{flash banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
11155
11156 Return information about the flash banks
11157
11158 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
11159
11160 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
11161 its execution. Example:
11162
11163 @example
11164 > capture "reset init"
11165 @end example
11166
11167 @end itemize
11168
11169 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
11170 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
11171 called "flash_banks".
11172
11173 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
11174
11175 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
11176 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
11177 holds one of the following values:
11178
11179 @itemize @bullet
11180 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
11181 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
11182 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
11183 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
11184 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
11185 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
11186 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
11187 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
11188 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
11189 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
11190 @end itemize
11191
11192 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
11193
11194 @quotation Note
11195 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
11196 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
11197 @code{jim_platform} (because it
11198 is jim, not real tcl).
11199 @end quotation
11200
11201 @section Tcl RPC server
11202 @cindex RPC
11203
11204 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
11205 commands and receive the results.
11206
11207 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
11208 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
11209 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
11210 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
11211 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
11212
11213 It is not needed anymore to prefix the OpenOCD commands with
11214 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. But sometimes you might need the
11215 @command{capture} command.
11216
11217 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
11218
11219 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
11220 @cindex RPC Notifications
11221
11222 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11223 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11224
11225 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
11226 in the following format.
11227
11228 @verbatim
11229 type target_event event [event-name]
11230 type target_state state [state-name]
11231 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
11232 @end verbatim
11233
11234 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
11235 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
11236 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11237 Defaults to off.
11238
11239 @end deffn
11240
11241 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
11242 @cindex RPC trace output
11243
11244 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
11245 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
11246
11247 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
11248
11249 @verbatim
11250 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
11251 @end verbatim
11252
11253 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
11254 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
11255 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
11256 Defaults to off.
11257
11258 See an example application here:
11259 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
11260
11261 @end deffn
11262
11263 @node FAQ
11264 @chapter FAQ
11265 @cindex faq
11266 @enumerate
11267 @anchor{faqrtck}
11268 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
11269 @cindex RTCK
11270 @cindex adaptive clocking
11271 @*
11272
11273 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
11274 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
11275 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
11276 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
11277
11278 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
11279 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
11280 for example. There are 2 basic options:
11281 @enumerate
11282 @item
11283 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
11284 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
11285 @item
11286 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
11287 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
11288 @end enumerate
11289
11290 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
11291 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
11292 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
11293 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
11294 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
11295 power).
11296
11297 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
11298 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
11299 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
11300 ARM926 scenario).
11301 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
11302 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
11303 JTAG can use a faster clock.
11304
11305 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
11306 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
11307 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
11308 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
11309
11310 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
11311
11312 In order to make use of this,
11313 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
11314 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
11315
11316 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
11317 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
11318 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
11319 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
11320 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
11321
11322 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
11323 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
11324 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
11325 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
11326
11327 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
11328 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
11329 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
11330 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
11331 with a CPLD.
11332 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
11333 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
11334 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
11335 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
11336 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
11337 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
11338
11339 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
11340
11341 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
11342
11343 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
11344 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
11345 depending on the chips on your board.
11346 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
11347 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
11348 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
11349
11350 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
11351 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
11352 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
11353
11354 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
11355 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
11356 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
11357 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
11358
11359 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
11360 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
11361 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
11362 this way.
11363
11364 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
11365 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
11366 clock rate.
11367 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
11368 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
11369 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
11370
11371 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
11372
11373 @example
11374 # Example: 1.234MHz
11375 adapter speed 1234
11376 @end example
11377
11378
11379 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
11380
11381 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
11382 around Windows filenames.
11383
11384 @example
11385 > echo \a
11386
11387 > echo @{\a@}
11388 \a
11389 > echo "\a"
11390
11391 >
11392 @end example
11393
11394
11395 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
11396
11397 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
11398 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
11399 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
11400
11401 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
11402 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
11403 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
11404
11405 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
11406 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
11407 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
11408
11409 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
11410
11411 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
11412 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
11413 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
11414 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
11415
11416 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
11417 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
11418 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
11419
11420 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
11421 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
11422
11423 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
11424 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
11425 memory read caused data abort".
11426
11427 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
11428 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
11429 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
11430 be done, feel free to add this here.
11431
11432 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
11433 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
11434 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
11435 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
11436 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
11437 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
11438 gracefully stops.
11439
11440 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
11441 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
11442 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
11443
11444 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
11445 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
11446 bytes. Painful...
11447
11448
11449 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
11450 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
11451
11452 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
11453 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{reset_config
11454 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
11455 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
11456 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
11457 reset, everything else should work fine.
11458
11459 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
11460 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
11461 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
11462 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
11463
11464 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
11465 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
11466 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
11467 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
11468
11469 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
11470
11471 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
11472 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
11473 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
11474
11475 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
11476 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
11477
11478 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
11479 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
11480 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
11481 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
11482 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
11483 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
11484 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
11485 clock frequency?
11486
11487 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
11488 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
11489 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
11490 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
11491 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
11492
11493 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
11494
11495 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
11496 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
11497 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
11498 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
11499 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
11500 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
11501 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
11502
11503 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
11504
11505 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
11506 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
11507 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
11508 up DRAM and loading it with code.
11509
11510 @anchor{faqtaporder}
11511 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
11512 particular order?
11513
11514 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
11515 the same order used by the hardware.
11516
11517 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
11518 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
11519 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
11520 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
11521 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
11522 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
11523
11524 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
11525 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
11526 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
11527 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
11528
11529 @itemize @bullet
11530 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
11531 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
11532 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
11533 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
11534 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
11535 @end itemize
11536
11537 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
11538
11539 @itemize @bullet
11540 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
11541 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
11542 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
11543 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
11544 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
11545 @end itemize
11546
11547
11548 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
11549 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
11550 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
11551
11552 TODO.
11553
11554 @end enumerate
11555
11556 @node Tcl Crash Course
11557 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
11558 @cindex Tcl
11559
11560 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
11561 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
11562 how the Tcl scripts work.
11563
11564 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
11565 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
11566 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
11567 OpenOCD.
11568
11569 @section Tcl Rule #1
11570 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
11571 @enumerate
11572 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
11573 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11574 @end enumerate
11575
11576 The Tcl equal is this:
11577
11578 @enumerate
11579 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
11580 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11581 @end enumerate
11582
11583 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
11584 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
11585
11586 @section Tcl Rule #1b
11587 There is a second pair of rules.
11588 @enumerate
11589 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
11590 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
11591 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
11592 in Tcl.
11593 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
11594 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
11595 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
11596 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
11597 @end enumerate
11598
11599 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
11600 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
11601 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
11602 Everything is a string}
11603
11604 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
11605 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
11606 difference is subtle.
11607 @enumerate
11608 @item Parse Time
11609 @item Evaluation Time
11610 @end enumerate
11611
11612 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
11613 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
11614 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
11615
11616 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
11617 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
11618 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
11619 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
11620
11621 @itemize @bullet
11622 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
11623 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
11624 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
11625 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
11626 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
11627 @example
11628 # bash example
11629 X=`date`
11630 echo "The Date is: $X"
11631 # Tcl example
11632 set X [date]
11633 puts "The Date is: $X"
11634 @end example
11635 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
11636 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
11637 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
11638 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
11639 is a string}
11640 @example
11641 set x "Dinner"
11642 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
11643 @end example
11644 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
11645 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
11646 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
11647 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
11648 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
11649 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
11650 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
11651 @end itemize
11652
11653 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
11654
11655 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
11656
11657 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
11658
11659 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
11660 the normal way.
11661
11662 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
11663 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
11664 line is immediately executed.
11665
11666 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
11667 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
11668
11669 @subsection Command Execution
11670
11671 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
11672 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
11673 control flow operators.
11674
11675 Commands are executed like this:
11676
11677 @enumerate
11678 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
11679 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
11680 @item Repeat until End Of File.
11681 @end enumerate
11682
11683 It sort of works like this:
11684 @example
11685 for(;;)@{
11686 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
11687
11688 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
11689
11690 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
11691 @}
11692 @end example
11693
11694 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
11695 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
11696 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
11697 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
11698 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
11699 ``LookupCommand()''
11700
11701 @subsection The FOR command
11702
11703 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
11704 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
11705 command just like any other command.
11706
11707 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
11708 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
11709 are:
11710
11711 @enumerate 0
11712 @item The ascii text 'for'
11713 @item The start text
11714 @item The test expression
11715 @item The next text
11716 @item The body text
11717 @end enumerate
11718
11719 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
11720 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
11721 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
11722 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
11723
11724 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
11725 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
11726
11727 @example
11728 int
11729 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
11730 int *argc,
11731 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
11732 @end example
11733
11734 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
11735 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
11736 still operates in the same basic way.
11737
11738 @subsection FOR command implementation
11739
11740 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
11741 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
11742
11743 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
11744
11745 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
11746
11747 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
11748 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
11749 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
11750
11751 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
11752 expression and returns a value.
11753
11754 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
11755 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
11756 @example
11757 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
11758
11759 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
11760
11761 int
11762 MyForCommand( void *interp,
11763 int argc,
11764 char **argv )
11765 @{
11766 if( argc != 5 )@{
11767 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
11768 return ERROR;
11769 @}
11770
11771 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
11772
11773 // Execute the start statement.
11774 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
11775
11776 // Top of loop test
11777 for(;;)@{
11778 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
11779 if( i == 0 )
11780 break;
11781
11782 // Execute the body
11783 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
11784
11785 // Execute the LOOP part
11786 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
11787 @}
11788
11789 // Return no error
11790 SetResult( interp, "" );
11791 return SUCCESS;
11792 @}
11793 @end example
11794
11795 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
11796 in the same basic way.
11797
11798 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
11799
11800 @subsection source and find commands
11801 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
11802 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
11803 @*Remember the parsing rules
11804 @enumerate
11805 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
11806 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
11807 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
11808 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
11809 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
11810 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
11811 That character begins Tcl comments.)
11812 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
11813 it reads a file and executes as a script.
11814 @end enumerate
11815 @subsection format command
11816 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
11817 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
11818 @b{sprintf()}.
11819 @b{Example}
11820 @example
11821 set x 6
11822 set y 7
11823 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
11824 @end example
11825 @enumerate
11826 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
11827 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
11828 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
11829 @* Refer to Rule #1
11830 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
11831 @* Refer to Rule #1.
11832 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
11833 @end enumerate
11834 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
11835 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
11836 @example
11837 #1 Good
11838 proc someproc @{@} @{
11839 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
11840 @}
11841 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
11842 #2 Good - no variables
11843 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
11844 #3 Good Curly Braces
11845 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
11846 puts "Time: [date]"
11847 @}
11848 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
11849 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
11850 @end example
11851 @enumerate
11852 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
11853 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
11854 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
11855 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
11856 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
11857 command.
11858 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
11859 @*There are 4 examples:
11860 @enumerate
11861 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
11862 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
11863 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
11864 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
11865 @end enumerate
11866
11867 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
11868 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
11869 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
11870
11871 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
11872 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
11873 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
11874 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
11875 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
11876 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
11877 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
11878 @end enumerate
11879 @subsection Global Variables
11880 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
11881 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
11882 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
11883 @example
11884 proc myproc @{ @} @{
11885 set y 0 #Local variable Y
11886 global x #Global variable X
11887 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
11888 @}
11889 @end example
11890 @section Other Tcl Hacks
11891 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
11892 @example
11893 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
11894 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
11895 # Create var name
11896 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
11897 # Make it a global
11898 global $vn
11899 # Set it.
11900 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
11901 @}
11902 @end example
11903 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
11904 @example
11905 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
11906 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
11907 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
11908 @}
11909 @end example
11910
11911 @include fdl.texi
11912
11913 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
11914 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
11915 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
11916 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
11917 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
11918 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
11919
11920 @printindex cp
11921
11922 @node Command and Driver Index
11923 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
11924 @printindex fn
11925
11926 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)